1 //===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2 //
3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 // This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
15 #include "TreeTransform.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
32 #include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
33 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
34 #include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
35 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
36 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h"
37 #include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
38 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
39 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
40 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
41 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
42 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
43 #include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h"
44 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
45 #include "llvm/Support/ConvertUTF.h"
46 using namespace clang;
47 using namespace sema;
48
49 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without
50 /// emitting diagnostics.
CanUseDecl(NamedDecl * D)51 bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D) {
52 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
53 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D))
54 return false;
55
56 // See if this is a deleted function.
57 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
58 if (FD->isDeleted())
59 return false;
60
61 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it,
62 // then we can't use it either.
63 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
64 DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false))
65 return false;
66 }
67
68 // See if this function is unavailable.
69 if (D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable &&
70 cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable)
71 return false;
72
73 return true;
74 }
75
DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema & S,NamedDecl * D,SourceLocation Loc)76 static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
77 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
78 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) {
79 const Decl *DC = cast_or_null<Decl>(S.getCurObjCLexicalContext());
80 if (DC && !DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
81 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
82 }
83 }
84
HasRedeclarationWithoutAvailabilityInCategory(const Decl * D)85 static bool HasRedeclarationWithoutAvailabilityInCategory(const Decl *D) {
86 const auto *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
87 if (!OMD)
88 return false;
89 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OID = OMD->getClassInterface();
90 if (!OID)
91 return false;
92
93 for (const ObjCCategoryDecl *Cat : OID->visible_categories())
94 if (ObjCMethodDecl *CatMeth =
95 Cat->getMethod(OMD->getSelector(), OMD->isInstanceMethod()))
96 if (!CatMeth->hasAttr<AvailabilityAttr>())
97 return true;
98 return false;
99 }
100
101 static AvailabilityResult
DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(Sema & S,NamedDecl * D,SourceLocation Loc,const ObjCInterfaceDecl * UnknownObjCClass,bool ObjCPropertyAccess)102 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
103 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass,
104 bool ObjCPropertyAccess) {
105 // See if this declaration is unavailable or deprecated.
106 std::string Message;
107 AvailabilityResult Result = D->getAvailability(&Message);
108
109 // For typedefs, if the typedef declaration appears available look
110 // to the underlying type to see if it is more restrictive.
111 while (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
112 if (Result == AR_Available) {
113 if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) {
114 D = TT->getDecl();
115 Result = D->getAvailability(&Message);
116 continue;
117 }
118 }
119 break;
120 }
121
122 // Forward class declarations get their attributes from their definition.
123 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
124 if (IDecl->getDefinition()) {
125 D = IDecl->getDefinition();
126 Result = D->getAvailability(&Message);
127 }
128 }
129
130 if (const EnumConstantDecl *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D))
131 if (Result == AR_Available) {
132 const DeclContext *DC = ECD->getDeclContext();
133 if (const EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(DC))
134 Result = TheEnumDecl->getAvailability(&Message);
135 }
136
137 const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = nullptr;
138 if (Result == AR_Deprecated || Result == AR_Unavailable ||
139 AR_NotYetIntroduced) {
140 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
141 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = MD->findPropertyDecl()) {
142 AvailabilityResult PDeclResult = PD->getAvailability(nullptr);
143 if (PDeclResult == Result)
144 ObjCPDecl = PD;
145 }
146 }
147 }
148
149 switch (Result) {
150 case AR_Available:
151 break;
152
153 case AR_Deprecated:
154 if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Deprecated)
155 S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Deprecation,
156 D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl,
157 ObjCPropertyAccess);
158 break;
159
160 case AR_NotYetIntroduced: {
161 // Don't do this for enums, they can't be redeclared.
162 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<EnumDecl>(D))
163 break;
164
165 bool Warn = !D->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()->isInherited();
166 // Objective-C method declarations in categories are not modelled as
167 // redeclarations, so manually look for a redeclaration in a category
168 // if necessary.
169 if (Warn && HasRedeclarationWithoutAvailabilityInCategory(D))
170 Warn = false;
171 // In general, D will point to the most recent redeclaration. However,
172 // for `@class A;` decls, this isn't true -- manually go through the
173 // redecl chain in that case.
174 if (Warn && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D))
175 for (Decl *Redecl = D->getMostRecentDecl(); Redecl && Warn;
176 Redecl = Redecl->getPreviousDecl())
177 if (!Redecl->hasAttr<AvailabilityAttr>() ||
178 Redecl->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()->isInherited())
179 Warn = false;
180
181 if (Warn)
182 S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Partial, D, Message, Loc,
183 UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl,
184 ObjCPropertyAccess);
185 break;
186 }
187
188 case AR_Unavailable:
189 if (S.getCurContextAvailability() != AR_Unavailable)
190 S.EmitAvailabilityWarning(Sema::AD_Unavailable,
191 D, Message, Loc, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPDecl,
192 ObjCPropertyAccess);
193 break;
194
195 }
196 return Result;
197 }
198
199 /// \brief Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted.
NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl * Decl)200 void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) {
201 assert(Decl->isDeleted());
202
203 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl);
204
205 if (Method && Method->isDeleted() && Method->isDefaulted()) {
206 // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration.
207 if (!Method->isImplicit())
208 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted);
209
210 // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly
211 // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies.
212 CXXSpecialMember CSM = getSpecialMember(Method);
213 if (CSM != CXXInvalid)
214 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Method, CSM, /*Diagnose=*/true);
215
216 return;
217 }
218
219 if (CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl)) {
220 if (CXXConstructorDecl *BaseCD =
221 const_cast<CXXConstructorDecl*>(CD->getInheritedConstructor())) {
222 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_inherited_deleted_here);
223 if (BaseCD->isDeleted()) {
224 NoteDeletedFunction(BaseCD);
225 } else {
226 // FIXME: An explanation of why exactly it can't be inherited
227 // would be nice.
228 Diag(BaseCD->getLocation(), diag::note_cannot_inherit);
229 }
230 return;
231 }
232 }
233
234 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here)
235 << Decl << true;
236 }
237
238 /// \brief Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an
239 /// explicit storage class.
hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl * D)240 static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) {
241 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
242 if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None)
243 return true;
244 }
245 return false;
246 }
247
248 /// \brief Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a
249 /// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3).
250 ///
251 /// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but
252 /// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode
253 /// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6)
254 /// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't
255 /// prove that there are errors.
diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema & S,const NamedDecl * D,SourceLocation Loc)256 static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S,
257 const NamedDecl *D,
258 SourceLocation Loc) {
259 // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in
260 // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically
261 // correct but benign.
262 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
263 return;
264
265 // Check if this is an inlined function or method.
266 FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl();
267 if (!Current)
268 return;
269 if (!Current->isInlined())
270 return;
271 if (!Current->isExternallyVisible())
272 return;
273
274 // Check if the decl has internal linkage.
275 if (D->getFormalLinkage() != InternalLinkage)
276 return;
277
278 // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if
279 // (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file,
280 // and probably won't be included anywhere else.
281 // (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function.
282 // (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function.
283 // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on
284 // wrappers for simple C library functions.
285 const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
286 bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc);
287 if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn)
288 DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>();
289
290 S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline_quiet
291 : diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline)
292 << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D;
293
294 S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current);
295
296 S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
297 << D;
298 }
299
MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl * Cur)300 void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) {
301 const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl();
302
303 // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible.
304 if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) {
305 SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin();
306 Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static)
307 << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static ");
308 }
309 }
310
311 /// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
312 /// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
313 ///
314 /// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
315 /// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
316 /// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
317 /// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
318 /// function is being used.
319 ///
320 /// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
321 /// referenced), false otherwise.
322 ///
DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl * D,SourceLocation Loc,const ObjCInterfaceDecl * UnknownObjCClass,bool ObjCPropertyAccess)323 bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
324 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass,
325 bool ObjCPropertyAccess) {
326 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
327 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
328 // emit them now.
329 SuppressedDiagnosticsMap::iterator
330 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
331 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
332 SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
333 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
334 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
335
336 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
337 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this
338 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
339 // diagnostics again.
340 Suppressed.clear();
341 }
342
343 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3:
344 // The function 'main' shall not be used within a program.
345 if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain())
346 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used);
347 }
348
349 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing.
350 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) {
351 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
352 << D->getDeclName();
353 return true;
354 }
355
356 // See if this is a deleted function.
357 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
358 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
359 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
360 NoteDeletedFunction(FD);
361 return true;
362 }
363
364 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it,
365 // then we can't use it either.
366 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
367 DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc))
368 return true;
369 }
370 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(*this, D, Loc, UnknownObjCClass,
371 ObjCPropertyAccess);
372
373 DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc);
374
375 diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc);
376
377 return false;
378 }
379
380 /// \brief Retrieve the message suffix that should be added to a
381 /// diagnostic complaining about the given function being deleted or
382 /// unavailable.
getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(const FunctionDecl * FD)383 std::string Sema::getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
384 std::string Message;
385 if (FD->getAvailability(&Message))
386 return ": " + Message;
387
388 return std::string();
389 }
390
391 /// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or
392 /// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and
393 /// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are
394 /// satisfied.
DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl * D,SourceLocation Loc,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args)395 void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
396 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
397 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
398 if (!attr)
399 return;
400
401 // The number of formal parameters of the declaration.
402 unsigned numFormalParams;
403
404 // The kind of declaration. This is also an index into a %select in
405 // the diagnostic.
406 enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType;
407
408 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
409 numFormalParams = MD->param_size();
410 calleeType = CT_Method;
411 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
412 numFormalParams = FD->param_size();
413 calleeType = CT_Function;
414 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) {
415 QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType();
416 const FunctionType *fn = nullptr;
417 if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
418 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
419 if (!fn) return;
420 calleeType = CT_Function;
421 } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
422 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
423 calleeType = CT_Block;
424 } else {
425 return;
426 }
427
428 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) {
429 numFormalParams = proto->getNumParams();
430 } else {
431 numFormalParams = 0;
432 }
433 } else {
434 return;
435 }
436
437 // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which
438 // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments. This is
439 // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters,
440 // but the language forces you to have at least one.
441 unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
442 assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel");
443 numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos);
444
445 // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel.
446 unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel();
447
448 // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters,
449 // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain.
450 if (Args.size() < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) {
451 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
452 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType);
453 return;
454 }
455
456 // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression.
457 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1];
458 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
459 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
460 if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(sentinelExpr)) return;
461
462 // Pick a reasonable string to insert. Optimistically use 'nil', 'nullptr',
463 // or 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context. Only use
464 // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the
465 // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers.
466 SourceLocation MissingNilLoc
467 = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getLocEnd());
468 std::string NullValue;
469 if (calleeType == CT_Method && PP.isMacroDefined("nil"))
470 NullValue = "nil";
471 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
472 NullValue = "nullptr";
473 else if (PP.isMacroDefined("NULL"))
474 NullValue = "NULL";
475 else
476 NullValue = "(void*) 0";
477
478 if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid())
479 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(calleeType);
480 else
481 Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel)
482 << int(calleeType)
483 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue);
484 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType);
485 }
486
getExprRange(Expr * E) const487 SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const {
488 return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
489 }
490
491 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
492 // Standard Promotions and Conversions
493 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
494
495 /// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr * E)496 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E) {
497 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
498 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
499 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
500 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
501 E = result.get();
502 }
503
504 QualType Ty = E->getType();
505 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
506
507 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) {
508 // If we are here, we are not calling a function but taking
509 // its address (which is not allowed in OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3).
510 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
511 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address);
512 return ExprError();
513 }
514 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
515 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get();
516 } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
517 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
518 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
519 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
520 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
521 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
522 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
523 //
524 // C++ 4.2p1:
525 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
526 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
527 //
528 if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue())
529 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
530 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
531 }
532 return E;
533 }
534
CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema & S,Expr * E)535 static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
536 // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer. If so,
537 // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
538 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
539 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
540 // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check.
541 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
542 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
543 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
544 isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
545 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
546 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
547 S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
548 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange());
549 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO,
550 S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null));
551 }
552 }
553
DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema & S,const ObjCIvarRefExpr * OIRE,SourceLocation AssignLoc,const Expr * RHS)554 static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE,
555 SourceLocation AssignLoc,
556 const Expr* RHS) {
557 const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl();
558 if (!IV)
559 return;
560
561 DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName();
562 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
563 if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa"))
564 return;
565
566 const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase();
567 QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
568 if (OIRE->isArrow())
569 BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType();
570 if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
571 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) {
572 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr;
573 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
574 if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass()
575 && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) {
576 if (RHS) {
577 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass =
578 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope,
579 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"),
580 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName);
581 if (ObjectSetClass) {
582 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getLocEnd());
583 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) <<
584 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") <<
585 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(),
586 AssignLoc), ",") <<
587 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")");
588 }
589 else
590 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign);
591 } else {
592 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass =
593 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope,
594 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"),
595 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName);
596 if (ObjectGetClass)
597 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) <<
598 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") <<
599 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
600 SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(),
601 OIRE->getLocEnd()), ")");
602 else
603 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use);
604 }
605 S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl);
606 }
607 }
608 }
609
DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr * E)610 ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) {
611 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here.
612 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
613 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
614 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
615 E = result.get();
616 }
617
618 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
619 // A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be
620 // converted to a prvalue.
621 if (!E->isGLValue()) return E;
622
623 QualType T = E->getType();
624 assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?");
625
626 // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of
627 // expressions of certain types in C++.
628 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
629 (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy ||
630 T->isDependentType() ||
631 T->isRecordType()))
632 return E;
633
634 // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and
635 // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why. It's
636 // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo
637 // lvalue-to-rvalue at all. Note that expressions of unqualified
638 // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be.
639 if (T->isVoidType())
640 return E;
641
642 // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type.
643 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp16 &&
644 T->isHalfType()) {
645 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store)
646 << 0 << T;
647 return ExprError();
648 }
649
650 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E);
651 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
652 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope,
653 &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"),
654 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName);
655 if (ObjectGetClass)
656 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) <<
657 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getLocStart(), "object_getClass(") <<
658 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(
659 SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")");
660 else
661 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use);
662 }
663 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE =
664 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()))
665 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr);
666
667 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
668 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the
669 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
670 // rvalue is T.
671 //
672 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
673 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
674 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
675 // type of the lvalue.
676 if (T.hasQualifiers())
677 T = T.getUnqualifiedType();
678
679 UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E);
680
681 // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to
682 // balance that.
683 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
684 E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)
685 ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
686
687 ExprResult Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_LValueToRValue, E,
688 nullptr, VK_RValue);
689
690 // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
691 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
692 // of the type of the lvalue ...
693 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) {
694 T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType();
695 Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(),
696 nullptr, VK_RValue);
697 }
698
699 return Res;
700 }
701
DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr * E)702 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E) {
703 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
704 if (Res.isInvalid())
705 return ExprError();
706 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get());
707 if (Res.isInvalid())
708 return ExprError();
709 return Res;
710 }
711
712 /// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion
713 /// performed on a function designator of a call expression.
CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr * E)714 ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
715 QualType Ty = E->getType();
716 ExprResult Res = E;
717 // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer
718 // to function type.
719 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) {
720 Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
721 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get();
722 if (Res.isInvalid())
723 return ExprError();
724 }
725 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get());
726 if (Res.isInvalid())
727 return ExprError();
728 return Res.get();
729 }
730
731 /// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
732 /// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
733 /// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
734 /// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
735 /// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
UsualUnaryConversions(Expr * E)736 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) {
737 // First, convert to an r-value.
738 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
739 if (Res.isInvalid())
740 return ExprError();
741 E = Res.get();
742
743 QualType Ty = E->getType();
744 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
745
746 // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported
747 if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType)
748 return ImpCastExprToType(Res.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast);
749
750 // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically
751 // promotable type.
752 if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
753 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
754 //
755 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
756 // unsigned int may be used:
757 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
758 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
759 // and unsigned int.
760 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
761 //
762 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
763 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
764 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
765 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
766
767 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E);
768 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
769 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get();
770 return E;
771 }
772 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
773 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
774 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get();
775 return E;
776 }
777 }
778 return E;
779 }
780
781 /// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
782 /// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16
783 /// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by
784 /// UsualUnaryConversions().
DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr * E)785 ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) {
786 QualType Ty = E->getType();
787 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
788
789 ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
790 if (Res.isInvalid())
791 return ExprError();
792 E = Res.get();
793
794 // If this is a 'float' or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to
795 // double.
796 const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
797 if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half ||
798 BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float))
799 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
800
801 // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument
802 // promotion, even on class types, but note:
803 // C++11 [conv.lval]p2:
804 // When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated
805 // operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the
806 // referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue
807 // has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary
808 // of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion
809 // is a prvalue for the temporary.
810 // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in
811 // potentially potentially evaluated contexts.
812 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) {
813 ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization(
814 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()),
815 E->getExprLoc(), E);
816 if (Temp.isInvalid())
817 return ExprError();
818 E = Temp.get();
819 }
820
821 return E;
822 }
823
824 /// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression.
825 /// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed
826 /// when we're in an unevaluated context.
isValidVarArgType(const QualType & Ty)827 Sema::VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) {
828 if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) {
829 // C++11 [expr.call]p7:
830 // After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic,
831 // enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program
832 // is ill-formed.
833 //
834 // Since we've already performed array-to-pointer and function-to-pointer
835 // decay, the only such type in C++ is cv void. This also handles
836 // initializer lists as variadic arguments.
837 if (Ty->isVoidType())
838 return VAK_Invalid;
839
840 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
841 return VAK_Invalid;
842 return VAK_Valid;
843 }
844
845 if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context))
846 return VAK_Valid;
847
848 // C++11 [expr.call]p7:
849 // Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9)
850 // having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor,
851 // or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter,
852 // is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics.
853 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType())
854 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
855 if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() &&
856 !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() &&
857 !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor())
858 return VAK_ValidInCXX11;
859
860 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType())
861 return VAK_Valid;
862
863 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
864 return VAK_Invalid;
865
866 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
867 return VAK_MSVCUndefined;
868
869 // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're
870 // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so.
871 return VAK_Undefined;
872 }
873
checkVariadicArgument(const Expr * E,VariadicCallType CT)874 void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) {
875 // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg.
876 const QualType &Ty = E->getType();
877 VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty);
878
879 // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs.
880 switch (VAK) {
881 case VAK_ValidInCXX11:
882 DiagRuntimeBehavior(
883 E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
884 PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
885 << Ty << CT);
886 // Fall through.
887 case VAK_Valid:
888 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
889 // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a
890 // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that.
891 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
892 PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg)
893 << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()");
894 }
895 break;
896
897 case VAK_Undefined:
898 case VAK_MSVCUndefined:
899 DiagRuntimeBehavior(
900 E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
901 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
902 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT);
903 break;
904
905 case VAK_Invalid:
906 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType())
907 DiagRuntimeBehavior(
908 E->getLocStart(), nullptr,
909 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
910 << Ty << CT);
911 else
912 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg)
913 << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT;
914 break;
915 }
916 }
917
918 /// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
919 /// will create a trap if the resulting type is not a POD type.
DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr * E,VariadicCallType CT,FunctionDecl * FDecl)920 ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT,
921 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
922 if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
923 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable.
924 if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
925 (CT == VariadicMethod ||
926 (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) {
927 E = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
928
929 // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking.
930 } else {
931 ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
932 if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
933 return ExprError();
934 E = ExprRes.get();
935 }
936 }
937
938 ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E);
939 if (ExprRes.isInvalid())
940 return ExprError();
941 E = ExprRes.get();
942
943 // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are
944 // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall().
945 if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VAK_Undefined) {
946 // Turn this into a trap.
947 CXXScopeSpec SS;
948 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc;
949 UnqualifiedId Name;
950 Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"),
951 E->getLocStart());
952 ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc,
953 Name, true, false);
954 if (TrapFn.isInvalid())
955 return ExprError();
956
957 ExprResult Call = ActOnCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(),
958 E->getLocStart(), None,
959 E->getLocEnd());
960 if (Call.isInvalid())
961 return ExprError();
962
963 ExprResult Comma = ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getLocStart(), tok::comma,
964 Call.get(), E);
965 if (Comma.isInvalid())
966 return ExprError();
967 return Comma.get();
968 }
969
970 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
971 RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(),
972 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument))
973 return ExprError();
974
975 return E;
976 }
977
978 /// \brief Converts an integer to complex float type. Helper function of
979 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
980 ///
981 /// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is
982 /// successfully converted to the complex type.
handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & IntExpr,ExprResult & ComplexExpr,QualType IntTy,QualType ComplexTy,bool SkipCast)983 static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr,
984 ExprResult &ComplexExpr,
985 QualType IntTy,
986 QualType ComplexTy,
987 bool SkipCast) {
988 if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true;
989 if (SkipCast) return false;
990 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
991 QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType();
992 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating);
993 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy,
994 CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
995 } else {
996 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
997 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy,
998 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
999 }
1000 return false;
1001 }
1002
1003 /// \brief Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types. Helper function of
1004 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType,bool IsCompAssign)1005 static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1006 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1007 QualType RHSType,
1008 bool IsCompAssign) {
1009 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type.
1010 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
1011 /*skipCast*/false))
1012 return LHSType;
1013 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1014 /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign))
1015 return RHSType;
1016
1017 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex.
1018 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the
1019 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds
1020 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands.
1021 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains.
1022 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real
1023 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's
1024 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example,
1025 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the
1026 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex".
1027
1028 // Compute the rank of the two types, regardless of whether they are complex.
1029 int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1030
1031 auto *LHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(LHSType);
1032 auto *RHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(RHSType);
1033 QualType LHSElementType =
1034 LHSComplexType ? LHSComplexType->getElementType() : LHSType;
1035 QualType RHSElementType =
1036 RHSComplexType ? RHSComplexType->getElementType() : RHSType;
1037
1038 QualType ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(LHSElementType);
1039 if (Order < 0) {
1040 // Promote the precision of the LHS if not an assignment.
1041 ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(RHSElementType);
1042 if (!IsCompAssign) {
1043 if (LHSComplexType)
1044 LHS =
1045 S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
1046 else
1047 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast);
1048 }
1049 } else if (Order > 0) {
1050 // Promote the precision of the RHS.
1051 if (RHSComplexType)
1052 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
1053 else
1054 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast);
1055 }
1056 return ResultType;
1057 }
1058
1059 /// \brief Hande arithmetic conversion from integer to float. Helper function
1060 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & FloatExpr,ExprResult & IntExpr,QualType FloatTy,QualType IntTy,bool ConvertFloat,bool ConvertInt)1061 static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr,
1062 ExprResult &IntExpr,
1063 QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy,
1064 bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) {
1065 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) {
1066 if (ConvertInt)
1067 // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type.
1068 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy,
1069 CK_IntegralToFloating);
1070 return FloatTy;
1071 }
1072
1073 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
1074 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType());
1075 QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy);
1076
1077 // _Complex int -> _Complex float
1078 if (ConvertInt)
1079 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result,
1080 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
1081
1082 // float -> _Complex float
1083 if (ConvertFloat)
1084 FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result,
1085 CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
1086
1087 return result;
1088 }
1089
1090 /// \brief Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types. Helper
1091 /// function of UsualArithmeticConversions()
handleFloatConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType,bool IsCompAssign)1092 static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1093 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1094 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
1095 bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType();
1096 bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType();
1097
1098 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand
1099 // to the bigger result.
1100 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) {
1101 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1102 if (order > 0) {
1103 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
1104 return LHSType;
1105 }
1106
1107 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison");
1108 if (!IsCompAssign)
1109 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast);
1110 return RHSType;
1111 }
1112
1113 if (LHSFloat) {
1114 // Half FP has to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported
1115 if (LHSType->isHalfType() && !S.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType)
1116 LHSType = S.Context.FloatTy;
1117
1118 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1119 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign,
1120 /*convertInt=*/ true);
1121 }
1122 assert(RHSFloat);
1123 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType,
1124 /*convertInt=*/ true,
1125 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign);
1126 }
1127
1128 typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType);
1129
1130 namespace {
1131 /// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to
1132 /// permit their use as function template parameters.
doIntegralCast(Sema & S,Expr * op,QualType toType)1133 ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) {
1134 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast);
1135 }
1136
doComplexIntegralCast(Sema & S,Expr * op,QualType toType)1137 ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) {
1138 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType),
1139 CK_IntegralComplexCast);
1140 }
1141 }
1142
1143 /// \brief Handle integer arithmetic conversions. Helper function of
1144 /// UsualArithmeticConversions()
1145 template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast>
handleIntegerConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType,bool IsCompAssign)1146 static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1147 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1148 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) {
1149 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8
1150 int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType);
1151 bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
1152 bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
1153 if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) {
1154 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type
1155 if (order >= 0) {
1156 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1157 return LHSType;
1158 } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1159 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1160 return RHSType;
1161 } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) {
1162 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the
1163 // signed type, so use the unsigned type
1164 if (RHSSigned) {
1165 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1166 return LHSType;
1167 } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1168 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1169 return RHSType;
1170 } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) {
1171 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that
1172 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so
1173 // use the signed type.
1174 if (LHSSigned) {
1175 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType);
1176 return LHSType;
1177 } else if (!IsCompAssign)
1178 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType);
1179 return RHSType;
1180 } else {
1181 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type,
1182 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long
1183 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding
1184 // to the signed type.
1185 QualType result =
1186 S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType);
1187 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result);
1188 if (!IsCompAssign)
1189 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result);
1190 return result;
1191 }
1192 }
1193
1194 /// \brief Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension. Helper function
1195 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions()
handleComplexIntConversion(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType,bool IsCompAssign)1196 static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
1197 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType,
1198 QualType RHSType,
1199 bool IsCompAssign) {
1200 const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
1201 const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType();
1202
1203 if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) {
1204 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1205 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1206 QualType ScalarType =
1207 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast>
1208 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign);
1209
1210 return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1211 }
1212
1213 if (LHSComplexInt) {
1214 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1215 QualType ScalarType =
1216 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
1217 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign);
1218 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1219 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType,
1220 CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
1221
1222 return ComplexType;
1223 }
1224
1225 assert(RHSComplexInt);
1226
1227 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType();
1228 QualType ScalarType =
1229 handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast>
1230 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign);
1231 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType);
1232
1233 if (!IsCompAssign)
1234 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType,
1235 CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
1236 return ComplexType;
1237 }
1238
1239 /// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
1240 /// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
1241 /// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
1242 /// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,bool IsCompAssign)1243 QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
1244 bool IsCompAssign) {
1245 if (!IsCompAssign) {
1246 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
1247 if (LHS.isInvalid())
1248 return QualType();
1249 }
1250
1251 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
1252 if (RHS.isInvalid())
1253 return QualType();
1254
1255 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
1256 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
1257 QualType LHSType =
1258 Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
1259 QualType RHSType =
1260 Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
1261
1262 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS.
1263 if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1264 LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType();
1265
1266 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
1267 if (LHSType == RHSType)
1268 return LHSType;
1269
1270 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
1271 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
1272 if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType())
1273 return QualType();
1274
1275 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type.
1276 QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType;
1277 if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType())
1278 LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType);
1279 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
1280 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
1281 LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
1282 if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && !IsCompAssign)
1283 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast);
1284
1285 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
1286 if (LHSType == RHSType)
1287 return LHSType;
1288
1289 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types.
1290
1291 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1).
1292 if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType())
1293 return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1294 IsCompAssign);
1295
1296 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
1297 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
1298 return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1299 IsCompAssign);
1300
1301 // Handle GCC complex int extension.
1302 if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType())
1303 return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
1304 IsCompAssign);
1305
1306 // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
1307 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
1308 (*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, IsCompAssign);
1309 }
1310
1311
1312 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1313 // Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
1314 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1315
1316
1317 ExprResult
ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,SourceLocation DefaultLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * ControllingExpr,ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes,ArrayRef<Expr * > ArgExprs)1318 Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
1319 SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
1320 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
1321 Expr *ControllingExpr,
1322 ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes,
1323 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) {
1324 unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size();
1325 assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size());
1326
1327 TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs];
1328 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1329 if (ArgTypes[i])
1330 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]);
1331 else
1332 Types[i] = nullptr;
1333 }
1334
1335 ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1336 ControllingExpr,
1337 llvm::makeArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs),
1338 ArgExprs);
1339 delete [] Types;
1340 return ER;
1341 }
1342
1343 ExprResult
CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,SourceLocation DefaultLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * ControllingExpr,ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo * > Types,ArrayRef<Expr * > Exprs)1344 Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc,
1345 SourceLocation DefaultLoc,
1346 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
1347 Expr *ControllingExpr,
1348 ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types,
1349 ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) {
1350 unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size();
1351 assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size());
1352 if (ControllingExpr->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
1353 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(ControllingExpr);
1354 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
1355 ControllingExpr = result.get();
1356 }
1357
1358 // The controlling expression is an unevaluated operand, so side effects are
1359 // likely unintended.
1360 if (ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() &&
1361 ControllingExpr->HasSideEffects(Context, false))
1362 Diag(ControllingExpr->getExprLoc(),
1363 diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context);
1364
1365 bool TypeErrorFound = false,
1366 IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(),
1367 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack
1368 = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack();
1369
1370 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1371 if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
1372 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
1373
1374 if (Types[i]) {
1375 if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack())
1376 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true;
1377
1378 if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) {
1379 IsResultDependent = true;
1380 } else {
1381 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a
1382 // complete object type other than a variably modified type."
1383 unsigned D = 0;
1384 if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType())
1385 D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete;
1386 else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType())
1387 D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject;
1388 else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
1389 D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified;
1390
1391 if (D != 0) {
1392 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D)
1393 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1394 << Types[i]->getType();
1395 TypeErrorFound = true;
1396 }
1397
1398 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic
1399 // selection shall specify compatible types."
1400 for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j)
1401 if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() &&
1402 Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(),
1403 Types[j]->getType())) {
1404 Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1405 diag::err_assoc_compatible_types)
1406 << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1407 << Types[j]->getType()
1408 << Types[i]->getType();
1409 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1410 diag::note_compat_assoc)
1411 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1412 << Types[i]->getType();
1413 TypeErrorFound = true;
1414 }
1415 }
1416 }
1417 }
1418 if (TypeErrorFound)
1419 return ExprError();
1420
1421 // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't
1422 // try to compute the result expression.
1423 if (IsResultDependent)
1424 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr(
1425 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1426 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack);
1427
1428 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices;
1429 unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U;
1430 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) {
1431 if (!Types[i])
1432 DefaultIndex = i;
1433 else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(),
1434 Types[i]->getType()))
1435 CompatIndices.push_back(i);
1436 }
1437
1438 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have
1439 // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic
1440 // association list."
1441 if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) {
1442 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
1443 // parenthesized in macro definitions.
1444 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
1445 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match)
1446 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType()
1447 << (unsigned) CompatIndices.size();
1448 for (SmallVectorImpl<unsigned>::iterator I = CompatIndices.begin(),
1449 E = CompatIndices.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1450 Diag(Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
1451 diag::note_compat_assoc)
1452 << Types[*I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()
1453 << Types[*I]->getType();
1454 }
1455 return ExprError();
1456 }
1457
1458 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association,
1459 // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of
1460 // the types named in its generic association list."
1461 if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) {
1462 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically
1463 // parenthesized in macro definitions.
1464 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens();
1465 Diag(ControllingExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match)
1466 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType();
1467 return ExprError();
1468 }
1469
1470 // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a
1471 // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression,
1472 // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression
1473 // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the
1474 // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association."
1475 unsigned ResultIndex =
1476 CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex;
1477
1478 return new (Context) GenericSelectionExpr(
1479 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc,
1480 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex);
1481 }
1482
1483 /// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the
1484 /// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it.
getUDSuffixLoc(Sema & S,SourceLocation TokLoc,unsigned Offset)1485 static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
1486 unsigned Offset) {
1487 return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(),
1488 S.getLangOpts());
1489 }
1490
1491 /// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up
1492 /// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it.
BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema & S,Scope * Scope,IdentifierInfo * UDSuffix,SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,SourceLocation LitEndLoc)1493 static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope,
1494 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix,
1495 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc,
1496 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
1497 SourceLocation LitEndLoc) {
1498 assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator");
1499
1500 QualType ArgTy[2];
1501 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
1502 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType();
1503 if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType())
1504 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]);
1505 }
1506
1507 DeclarationName OpName =
1508 S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
1509 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
1510 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
1511
1512 LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
1513 if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::makeArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()),
1514 /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false,
1515 /*AllowStringTemplate*/false) == Sema::LOLR_Error)
1516 return ExprError();
1517
1518 return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc);
1519 }
1520
1521 /// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
1522 /// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
1523 /// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
1524 /// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
1525 /// string.
1526 ///
1527 ExprResult
ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks,Scope * UDLScope)1528 Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) {
1529 assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!");
1530
1531 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP);
1532 if (Literal.hadError)
1533 return ExprError();
1534
1535 SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
1536 for (unsigned i = 0; i != StringToks.size(); ++i)
1537 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
1538
1539 QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy;
1540 StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii;
1541 if (Literal.isWide()) {
1542 CharTy = Context.getWideCharType();
1543 Kind = StringLiteral::Wide;
1544 } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) {
1545 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8;
1546 } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) {
1547 CharTy = Context.Char16Ty;
1548 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16;
1549 } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) {
1550 CharTy = Context.Char32Ty;
1551 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32;
1552 } else if (Literal.isPascal()) {
1553 CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
1554 }
1555
1556 QualType CharTyConst = CharTy;
1557 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
1558 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || getLangOpts().ConstStrings)
1559 CharTyConst.addConst();
1560
1561 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
1562 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
1563 // strings.
1564 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(CharTyConst,
1565 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
1566 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1567
1568 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: a string literal is in the constant address space.
1569 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
1570 StrTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(StrTy, LangAS::opencl_constant);
1571 }
1572
1573 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
1574 StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
1575 Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy,
1576 &StringTokLocs[0],
1577 StringTokLocs.size());
1578 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty())
1579 return Lit;
1580
1581 // We're building a user-defined literal.
1582 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
1583 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
1584 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()],
1585 Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
1586
1587 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
1588 if (!UDLScope)
1589 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl));
1590
1591 // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form
1592 // operator "" X (str, len)
1593 QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType();
1594
1595 DeclarationName OpName =
1596 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
1597 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
1598 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
1599
1600 QualType ArgTy[] = {
1601 Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType
1602 };
1603
1604 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1605 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy,
1606 /*AllowRaw*/false, /*AllowTemplate*/false,
1607 /*AllowStringTemplate*/true)) {
1608
1609 case LOLR_Cooked: {
1610 llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars());
1611 IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType,
1612 StringTokLocs[0]);
1613 Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg };
1614
1615 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back());
1616 }
1617
1618 case LOLR_StringTemplate: {
1619 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
1620
1621 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy);
1622 bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType();
1623 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned);
1624
1625 TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy);
1626 TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy));
1627 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo));
1628
1629 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) {
1630 Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I);
1631 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy);
1632 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo;
1633 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
1634 }
1635 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, StringTokLocs.back(),
1636 &ExplicitArgs);
1637 }
1638 case LOLR_Raw:
1639 case LOLR_Template:
1640 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
1641 case LOLR_Error:
1642 return ExprError();
1643 }
1644 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
1645 }
1646
1647 ExprResult
BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl * D,QualType Ty,ExprValueKind VK,SourceLocation Loc,const CXXScopeSpec * SS)1648 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
1649 SourceLocation Loc,
1650 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
1651 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
1652 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS);
1653 }
1654
1655 /// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a
1656 /// declaration that does not require a closure capture.
1657 ExprResult
BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl * D,QualType Ty,ExprValueKind VK,const DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,const CXXScopeSpec * SS,NamedDecl * FoundD,const TemplateArgumentListInfo * TemplateArgs)1658 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK,
1659 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1660 const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD,
1661 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1662 if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
1663 if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
1664 if (const FunctionDecl *Callee = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1665 if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Callee)) {
1666 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_ref_bad_target)
1667 << IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) << D->getIdentifier()
1668 << IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller);
1669 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
1670 << D->getIdentifier();
1671 return ExprError();
1672 }
1673 }
1674
1675 bool RefersToCapturedVariable =
1676 isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
1677 NeedToCaptureVariable(cast<VarDecl>(D), NameInfo.getLoc());
1678
1679 DeclRefExpr *E;
1680 if (isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
1681 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec =
1682 cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D);
1683
1684 E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)
1685 : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
1686 VarSpec->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), D,
1687 RefersToCapturedVariable, NameInfo.getLoc(), Ty, VK,
1688 FoundD, TemplateArgs);
1689 } else {
1690 assert(!TemplateArgs && "No template arguments for non-variable"
1691 " template specialization references");
1692 E = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context)
1693 : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
1694 SourceLocation(), D, RefersToCapturedVariable,
1695 NameInfo, Ty, VK, FoundD);
1696 }
1697
1698 MarkDeclRefReferenced(E);
1699
1700 if (getLangOpts().ObjCARCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) &&
1701 Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak &&
1702 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getLocStart()))
1703 recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(E);
1704
1705 // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member.
1706 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D);
1707 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
1708 E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField);
1709
1710 return E;
1711 }
1712
1713 /// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
1714 /// possibly a list of template arguments.
1715 ///
1716 /// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
1717 /// DecomposeTemplateName.
1718 ///
1719 /// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
1720 /// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
1721 /// some way.
1722 void
DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId & Id,TemplateArgumentListInfo & Buffer,DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,const TemplateArgumentListInfo * & TemplateArgs)1723 Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id,
1724 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
1725 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1726 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
1727 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
1728 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
1729 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
1730
1731 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
1732 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
1733 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
1734
1735 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
1736 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
1737 NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
1738 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
1739 } else {
1740 NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
1741 TemplateArgs = nullptr;
1742 }
1743 }
1744
emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(const TypoCorrection & TC,Sema & SemaRef,const CXXScopeSpec & SS,DeclarationName Typo,SourceLocation TypoLoc,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,unsigned DiagnosticID,unsigned DiagnosticSuggestID)1745 static void emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(
1746 const TypoCorrection &TC, Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1747 DeclarationName Typo, SourceLocation TypoLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
1748 unsigned DiagnosticID, unsigned DiagnosticSuggestID) {
1749 DeclContext *Ctx =
1750 SS.isEmpty() ? nullptr : SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1751 if (!TC) {
1752 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1753 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1754 if (Ctx)
1755 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Typo << Ctx
1756 << SS.getRange();
1757 else
1758 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, DiagnosticID) << Typo;
1759 return;
1760 }
1761
1762 std::string CorrectedStr = TC.getAsString(SemaRef.getLangOpts());
1763 bool DroppedSpecifier =
1764 TC.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Typo.getAsString() == CorrectedStr;
1765 unsigned NoteID =
1766 (TC.getCorrectionDecl() && isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(TC.getCorrectionDecl()))
1767 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl
1768 : diag::note_previous_decl;
1769 if (!Ctx)
1770 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(DiagnosticSuggestID) << Typo,
1771 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID));
1772 else
1773 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1774 << Typo << Ctx << DroppedSpecifier
1775 << SS.getRange(),
1776 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID));
1777 }
1778
1779 /// Diagnose an empty lookup.
1780 ///
1781 /// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
1782 bool
DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope * S,CXXScopeSpec & SS,LookupResult & R,std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC,TemplateArgumentListInfo * ExplicitTemplateArgs,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,TypoExpr ** Out)1783 Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
1784 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC,
1785 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
1786 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, TypoExpr **Out) {
1787 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
1788
1789 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
1790 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
1791 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
1792 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
1793 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
1794 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
1795 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
1796 }
1797
1798 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
1799 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
1800 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
1801 // dependent name.
1802 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isEmpty() && !CallsUndergoingInstantiation.empty())
1803 ? CurContext : nullptr;
1804 while (DC) {
1805 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
1806 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1807
1808 if (!R.empty()) {
1809 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
1810 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1811
1812 // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points
1813 // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a
1814 // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check.
1815 bool isDefaultArgument = !ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() &&
1816 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.back().Kind ==
1817 ActiveTemplateInstantiation::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation;
1818 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
1819 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
1820 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
1821 DC == CurMethod->getParent() && !isDefaultArgument;
1822
1823
1824 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
1825 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
1826 // Actually quite difficult!
1827 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
1828 diagnostic = diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup;
1829 if (isInstance) {
1830 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
1831 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
1832 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
1833 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
1834
1835 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod;
1836 if (CurMethod->isDependentContext())
1837 DepMethod = CurMethod;
1838 else if (CurMethod->getTemplatedKind() ==
1839 FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplateSpecialization)
1840 DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurMethod->getPrimaryTemplate()->
1841 getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl());
1842 else
1843 DepMethod = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(
1844 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
1845 assert(DepMethod && "No template pattern found");
1846
1847 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
1848 CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc());
1849 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
1850 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
1851 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
1852 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
1853 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
1854
1855 CXXScopeSpec SS;
1856 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
1857 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
1858 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
1859 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
1860 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
1861 ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), nullptr,
1862 R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1863 ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() ? &TList : nullptr);
1864 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
1865 } else {
1866 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1867 }
1868
1869 // Do we really want to note all of these?
1870 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
1871 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
1872
1873 // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation
1874 // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise
1875 // the function calling DiagnoseEmptyLookup will try to create an
1876 // implicit member call and this is wrong for default argument.
1877 if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) {
1878 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object);
1879 return true;
1880 }
1881
1882 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1883 return false;
1884 }
1885
1886 R.clear();
1887 }
1888
1889 // In Microsoft mode, if we are performing lookup from within a friend
1890 // function definition declared at class scope then we must set
1891 // DC to the lexical parent to be able to search into the parent
1892 // class.
1893 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isa<FunctionDecl>(DC) &&
1894 cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)->getFriendObjectKind() &&
1895 DC->getLexicalParent()->isRecord())
1896 DC = DC->getLexicalParent();
1897 else
1898 DC = DC->getParent();
1899 }
1900
1901 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
1902 TypoCorrection Corrected;
1903 if (S && Out) {
1904 SourceLocation TypoLoc = R.getNameLoc();
1905 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs &&
1906 "Diagnosing an empty lookup with explicit template args!");
1907 *Out = CorrectTypoDelayed(
1908 R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, &SS, std::move(CCC),
1909 [=](const TypoCorrection &TC) {
1910 emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(TC, *this, SS, Name, TypoLoc, Args,
1911 diagnostic, diagnostic_suggest);
1912 },
1913 nullptr, CTK_ErrorRecovery);
1914 if (*Out)
1915 return true;
1916 } else if (S && (Corrected =
1917 CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S,
1918 &SS, std::move(CCC), CTK_ErrorRecovery))) {
1919 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
1920 bool DroppedSpecifier =
1921 Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr;
1922 R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection());
1923
1924 bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false;
1925 bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false;
1926 NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl();
1927 if (ND) {
1928 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
1929 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(),
1930 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
1931 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
1932 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(),
1933 CDEnd = Corrected.end();
1934 CD != CDEnd; ++CD) {
1935 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD =
1936 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*CD))
1937 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
1938 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
1939 Args, OCS);
1940 else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD))
1941 if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0)
1942 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none),
1943 Args, OCS);
1944 }
1945 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) {
1946 case OR_Success:
1947 ND = Best->Function;
1948 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
1949 break;
1950 default:
1951 // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note.
1952 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
1953 break;
1954 }
1955 }
1956 R.addDecl(ND);
1957 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) {
1958 CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr;
1959 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) {
1960 const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType();
1961 Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
1962 }
1963 if (!Record)
1964 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(
1965 ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext());
1966 R.setNamingClass(Record);
1967 }
1968
1969 AcceptableWithRecovery =
1970 isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND);
1971 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
1972 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
1973 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
1974 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
1975 // to recover well anyway.
1976 AcceptableWithoutRecovery =
1977 isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND);
1978 } else {
1979 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
1980 // because we aren't able to recover.
1981 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true;
1982 }
1983
1984 if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) {
1985 unsigned NoteID = (Corrected.getCorrectionDecl() &&
1986 isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()))
1987 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl
1988 : diag::note_previous_decl;
1989 if (SS.isEmpty())
1990 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name,
1991 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery);
1992 else
1993 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1994 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1995 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange(),
1996 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery);
1997
1998 // Tell the callee whether to try to recover.
1999 return !AcceptableWithRecovery;
2000 }
2001 }
2002 R.clear();
2003
2004 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
2005 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
2006 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
2007 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
2008 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2009 << SS.getRange();
2010 return true;
2011 }
2012
2013 // Give up, we can't recover.
2014 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
2015 return true;
2016 }
2017
2018 /// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has
2019 /// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then
2020 /// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class. We can only
2021 /// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts
2022 /// where 'this' is available. This doesn't precisely match MSVC's
2023 /// instantiation model, but it's close enough.
2024 static Expr *
recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema & S,ASTContext & Context,DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,const TemplateArgumentListInfo * TemplateArgs)2025 recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context,
2026 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2027 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,
2028 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
2029 // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or
2030 // contexts where 'this' is available.
2031 QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType();
2032 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr;
2033 if (!ThisType.isNull())
2034 RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
2035 else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext))
2036 RD = MD->getParent();
2037 if (!RD || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases())
2038 return nullptr;
2039
2040 // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class. If 'this'
2041 // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit.
2042 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
2043 auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base);
2044 DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD;
2045
2046 if (!ThisType.isNull()) {
2047 DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->");
2048 return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
2049 Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true,
2050 /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc,
2051 /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
2052 }
2053
2054 // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class. This will
2055 // perform name lookup during template instantiation.
2056 CXXScopeSpec SS;
2057 auto *NNS =
2058 NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, true, RD->getTypeForDecl());
2059 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc));
2060 return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create(
2061 Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2062 TemplateArgs);
2063 }
2064
2065 ExprResult
ActOnIdExpression(Scope * S,CXXScopeSpec & SS,SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc,UnqualifiedId & Id,bool HasTrailingLParen,bool IsAddressOfOperand,std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC,bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier,Token * KeywordReplacement)2066 Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2067 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id,
2068 bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand,
2069 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> CCC,
2070 bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier, Token *KeywordReplacement) {
2071 assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
2072 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
2073 if (SS.isInvalid())
2074 return ExprError();
2075
2076 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
2077
2078 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
2079 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
2080 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
2081 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
2082
2083 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
2084 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
2085 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
2086
2087 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
2088 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
2089 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
2090 // (note: handled after lookup)
2091 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
2092 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
2093 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
2094 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
2095 // names a dependent type.
2096 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
2097 // we need to handle these differently.
2098 bool DependentID = false;
2099 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
2100 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
2101 DependentID = true;
2102 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
2103 if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) {
2104 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
2105 return ExprError();
2106 } else {
2107 DependentID = true;
2108 }
2109 }
2110
2111 if (DependentID)
2112 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2113 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2114
2115 // Perform the required lookup.
2116 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo,
2117 (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam)
2118 ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam : LookupOrdinaryName);
2119 if (TemplateArgs) {
2120 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
2121 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
2122 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
2123 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
2124 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
2125 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
2126 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
2127 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
2128
2129 if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization ||
2130 (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation))
2131 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2132 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2133 } else {
2134 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl();
2135 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
2136
2137 // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent
2138 // id-expression.
2139 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)
2140 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo,
2141 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs);
2142
2143 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
2144 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
2145 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
2146 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
2147 if (E.isInvalid())
2148 return ExprError();
2149
2150 if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>())
2151 return Ex;
2152 }
2153 }
2154
2155 if (R.isAmbiguous())
2156 return ExprError();
2157
2158 // This could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal in C90,
2159 // extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
2160 if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2161 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
2162 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
2163 }
2164
2165 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
2166 // argument-dependent lookup.
2167 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
2168
2169 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
2170 if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
2171 if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo,
2172 TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs))
2173 return E;
2174 }
2175
2176 // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly.
2177 if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier)
2178 return ExprError();
2179
2180 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
2181 // call, diagnose the problem.
2182 TypoExpr *TE = nullptr;
2183 auto DefaultValidator = llvm::make_unique<CorrectionCandidateCallback>(
2184 II, SS.isValid() ? SS.getScopeRep() : nullptr);
2185 DefaultValidator->IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand;
2186 assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) &&
2187 "Typo correction callback misconfigured");
2188 if (CCC) {
2189 // Make sure the callback knows what the typo being diagnosed is.
2190 CCC->setTypoName(II);
2191 if (SS.isValid())
2192 CCC->setTypoNNS(SS.getScopeRep());
2193 }
2194 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R,
2195 CCC ? std::move(CCC) : std::move(DefaultValidator),
2196 nullptr, None, &TE)) {
2197 if (TE && KeywordReplacement) {
2198 auto &State = getTypoExprState(TE);
2199 auto BestTC = State.Consumer->getNextCorrection();
2200 if (BestTC.isKeyword()) {
2201 auto *II = BestTC.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
2202 if (State.DiagHandler)
2203 State.DiagHandler(BestTC);
2204 KeywordReplacement->startToken();
2205 KeywordReplacement->setKind(II->getTokenID());
2206 KeywordReplacement->setIdentifierInfo(II);
2207 KeywordReplacement->setLocation(BestTC.getCorrectionRange().getBegin());
2208 // Clean up the state associated with the TypoExpr, since it has
2209 // now been diagnosed (without a call to CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr).
2210 clearDelayedTypo(TE);
2211 // Signal that a correction to a keyword was performed by returning a
2212 // valid-but-null ExprResult.
2213 return (Expr*)nullptr;
2214 }
2215 State.Consumer->resetCorrectionStream();
2216 }
2217 return TE ? TE : ExprError();
2218 }
2219
2220 assert(!R.empty() &&
2221 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
2222
2223 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
2224 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
2225 // reference the ivar.
2226 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
2227 R.clear();
2228 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
2229 // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable
2230 // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it.
2231 if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get())
2232 return ExprError();
2233 return E;
2234 }
2235 }
2236
2237 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
2238 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
2239
2240 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
2241 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
2242 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
2243 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
2244 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
2245 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
2246 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
2247 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
2248 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
2249 //
2250 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
2251 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
2252 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
2253 // non-static member function:
2254 //
2255 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
2256 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
2257 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
2258 // member function call.
2259 //
2260 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
2261 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
2262 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
2263 // instance method.
2264 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
2265 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
2266 if (!IsAddressOfOperand)
2267 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
2268 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
2269 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
2270 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
2271 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
2272 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
2273 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
2274 else
2275 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) ||
2276 isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) ||
2277 isa<MSPropertyDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
2278
2279 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
2280 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc,
2281 R, TemplateArgs);
2282 }
2283
2284 if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) {
2285
2286 // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it
2287 // in BuildTemplateIdExpr().
2288 // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration.
2289 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId &&
2290 Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) {
2291 assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() &&
2292 "There should only be one declaration found.");
2293 }
2294
2295 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs);
2296 }
2297
2298 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
2299 }
2300
2301 /// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
2302 /// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
2303 /// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
2304 /// this path.
2305 ExprResult
BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec & SS,const DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,bool IsAddressOfOperand,TypeSourceInfo ** RecoveryTSI)2306 Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2307 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2308 bool IsAddressOfOperand,
2309 TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) {
2310 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2311 if (!DC)
2312 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2313 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
2314
2315 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
2316 return ExprError();
2317
2318 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
2319 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
2320
2321 if (R.isAmbiguous())
2322 return ExprError();
2323
2324 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)
2325 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2326 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
2327
2328 if (R.empty()) {
2329 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
2330 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
2331 return ExprError();
2332 }
2333
2334 if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) {
2335 // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in
2336 // a dependent context. If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to
2337 // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode.
2338 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing;
2339 if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
2340 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing;
2341 SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc();
2342 auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID);
2343 D << SS.getScopeRep() << NameInfo.getName().getAsString()
2344 << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc());
2345
2346 // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE
2347 // context.
2348 if (!RecoveryTSI)
2349 return ExprError();
2350
2351 // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover.
2352 D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename ");
2353
2354 // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type.
2355 QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD);
2356 TypeLocBuilder TLB;
2357 TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc());
2358
2359 QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, Ty);
2360 ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET);
2361 QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
2362 QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
2363
2364 *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET);
2365
2366 return ExprEmpty();
2367 }
2368
2369 // Defend against this resolving to an implicit member access. We usually
2370 // won't get here if this might be a legitimate a class member (we end up in
2371 // BuildMemberReferenceExpr instead), but this can be valid if we're forming
2372 // a pointer-to-member or in an unevaluated context in C++11.
2373 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember() && !IsAddressOfOperand)
2374 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS,
2375 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
2376 R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
2377
2378 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /* ADL */ false);
2379 }
2380
2381 /// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
2382 /// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
2383 /// additional lookup.
2384 ///
2385 /// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
2386 /// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
2387 ///
2388 /// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
2389 ExprResult
LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult & Lookup,Scope * S,IdentifierInfo * II,bool AllowBuiltinCreation)2390 Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
2391 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
2392 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
2393 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
2394
2395 // Check for error condition which is already reported.
2396 if (!CurMethod)
2397 return ExprError();
2398
2399 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
2400 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
2401 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
2402 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
2403 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
2404
2405 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
2406 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
2407 // ivar, that's an error.
2408 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
2409
2410 bool LookForIvars;
2411 if (Lookup.empty())
2412 LookForIvars = true;
2413 else if (IsClassMethod)
2414 LookForIvars = false;
2415 else
2416 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
2417 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
2418 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr;
2419 if (LookForIvars) {
2420 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
2421 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
2422 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = nullptr;
2423 if (IFace && (IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared))) {
2424 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
2425 if (IsClassMethod)
2426 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
2427 << IV->getDeclName());
2428
2429 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
2430 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
2431 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
2432 return ExprError();
2433
2434 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
2435 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
2436 return ExprError();
2437
2438 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
2439 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
2440 !declaresSameEntity(ClassDeclared, IFace) &&
2441 !getLangOpts().DebuggerSupport)
2442 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
2443
2444 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
2445 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
2446 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
2447 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
2448 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
2449 SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedId::IK_ImplicitSelfParam);
2450 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
2451 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc;
2452 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec, TemplateKWLoc,
2453 SelfName, false, false);
2454 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
2455 return ExprError();
2456
2457 SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.get());
2458 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
2459 return ExprError();
2460
2461 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, IV, true);
2462
2463 ObjCMethodFamily MF = CurMethod->getMethodFamily();
2464 if (MF != OMF_init && MF != OMF_dealloc && MF != OMF_finalize &&
2465 !IvarBacksCurrentMethodAccessor(IFace, CurMethod, IV))
2466 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_direct_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
2467
2468 ObjCIvarRefExpr *Result = new (Context)
2469 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getUsageType(SelfExpr.get()->getType()), Loc,
2470 IV->getLocation(), SelfExpr.get(), true, true);
2471
2472 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
2473 if (IV->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) {
2474 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, Loc))
2475 recordUseOfEvaluatedWeak(Result);
2476 }
2477 if (CurContext->isClosure())
2478 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self)
2479 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "self->");
2480 }
2481
2482 return Result;
2483 }
2484 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
2485 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
2486 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface()) {
2487 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
2488 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
2489 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
2490 declaresSameEntity(IFace, ClassDeclared))
2491 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
2492 }
2493 }
2494 } else if (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
2495 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()) {
2496 // If accessing a stand-alone ivar in a class method, this is an error.
2497 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Lookup.getFoundDecl()))
2498 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
2499 << IV->getDeclName());
2500 }
2501
2502 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
2503 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
2504 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
2505 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2506 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
2507 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
2508 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
2509 Lookup.getNameLoc());
2510 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
2511 }
2512 }
2513 }
2514 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
2515 return ExprResult((Expr *)nullptr);
2516 }
2517
2518 /// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
2519 ///
2520 /// Logically this happens in three phases:
2521 ///
2522 /// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
2523 /// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
2524 /// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
2525 /// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
2526 ///
2527 /// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
2528 /// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
2529 /// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
2530 /// the class declaring the member.
2531 ///
2532 /// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
2533 /// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
2534 /// obey access control.
2535 ExprResult
PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr * From,NestedNameSpecifier * Qualifier,NamedDecl * FoundDecl,NamedDecl * Member)2536 Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From,
2537 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
2538 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
2539 NamedDecl *Member) {
2540 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
2541 if (!RD)
2542 return From;
2543
2544 QualType DestRecordType;
2545 QualType DestType;
2546 QualType FromRecordType;
2547 QualType FromType = From->getType();
2548 bool PointerConversions = false;
2549 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
2550 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
2551
2552 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2553 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
2554 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2555 PointerConversions = true;
2556 } else {
2557 DestType = DestRecordType;
2558 FromRecordType = FromType;
2559 }
2560 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
2561 if (Method->isStatic())
2562 return From;
2563
2564 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
2565 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
2566
2567 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2568 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2569 PointerConversions = true;
2570 } else {
2571 FromRecordType = FromType;
2572 DestType = DestRecordType;
2573 }
2574 } else {
2575 // No conversion necessary.
2576 return From;
2577 }
2578
2579 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
2580 return From;
2581
2582 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
2583 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
2584 return From;
2585
2586 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
2587 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
2588
2589 ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind();
2590
2591 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
2592 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
2593 // class name.
2594 //
2595 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
2596 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
2597 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
2598 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
2599 //
2600 // class Base { public: int x; };
2601 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
2602 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
2603 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
2604 //
2605 // void VeryDerived::f() {
2606 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
2607 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
2608 // }
2609 if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) {
2610 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
2611 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
2612
2613 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
2614
2615 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
2616 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
2617 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
2618 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
2619 CXXCastPath BasePath;
2620 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
2621 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
2622 return ExprError();
2623
2624 if (PointerConversions)
2625 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
2626 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2627 VK, &BasePath).get();
2628
2629 FromType = QType;
2630 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
2631
2632 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
2633 // we're done.
2634 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
2635 return From;
2636 }
2637 }
2638
2639 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
2640
2641 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
2642 // down to the using declaration's type.
2643 //
2644 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
2645 // class ever has member declarations.
2646 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
2647 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
2648 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
2649 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
2650
2651 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
2652 // conversion is non-trivial.
2653 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
2654 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
2655 CXXCastPath BasePath;
2656 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
2657 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
2658 return ExprError();
2659
2660 QualType UType = URecordType;
2661 if (PointerConversions)
2662 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
2663 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2664 VK, &BasePath).get();
2665 FromType = UType;
2666 FromRecordType = URecordType;
2667 }
2668
2669 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
2670 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
2671 IgnoreAccess = true;
2672 }
2673
2674 CXXCastPath BasePath;
2675 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
2676 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
2677 IgnoreAccess))
2678 return ExprError();
2679
2680 return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
2681 VK, &BasePath);
2682 }
2683
UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec & SS,const LookupResult & R,bool HasTrailingLParen)2684 bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2685 const LookupResult &R,
2686 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
2687 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
2688 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
2689 return false;
2690
2691 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
2692 if (SS.isSet())
2693 return false;
2694
2695 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
2696 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
2697 return false;
2698
2699 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
2700 // normal lookup:
2701 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
2702 NamedDecl *D = *I;
2703
2704 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2705 // -- a declaration of a class member
2706 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
2707 // original decl.
2708 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
2709 return false;
2710
2711 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2712 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
2713 // using-declaration
2714 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
2715 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
2716 // turn off ADL anyway).
2717 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2718 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2719 else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
2720 return false;
2721
2722 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2723 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
2724 // template
2725 // And also for builtin functions.
2726 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2727 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
2728
2729 // But also builtin functions.
2730 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
2731 return false;
2732 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
2733 return false;
2734 }
2735
2736 return true;
2737 }
2738
2739
2740 /// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
2741 /// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
2742 /// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
2743 /// will in fact be used.
CheckDeclInExpr(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,NamedDecl * D)2744 static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
2745 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
2746 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
2747 return true;
2748 }
2749
2750 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
2751 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
2752 return true;
2753 }
2754
2755 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
2756 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
2757 return true;
2758 }
2759
2760 return false;
2761 }
2762
BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec & SS,LookupResult & R,bool NeedsADL,bool AcceptInvalidDecl)2763 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2764 LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL,
2765 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) {
2766 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
2767 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
2768 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
2769 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(),
2770 R.getRepresentativeDecl(), nullptr,
2771 AcceptInvalidDecl);
2772
2773 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
2774 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
2775 // functions and function templates.
2776 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
2777 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
2778 return ExprError();
2779
2780 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
2781 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
2782 // we've picked a target.
2783 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2784
2785 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
2786 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(),
2787 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
2788 R.getLookupNameInfo(),
2789 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
2790 R.begin(), R.end());
2791
2792 return ULE;
2793 }
2794
2795 /// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec & SS,const DeclarationNameInfo & NameInfo,NamedDecl * D,NamedDecl * FoundD,const TemplateArgumentListInfo * TemplateArgs,bool AcceptInvalidDecl)2796 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(
2797 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D,
2798 NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2799 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) {
2800 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
2801 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
2802 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
2803
2804 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
2805 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
2806 return ExprError();
2807
2808 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
2809 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
2810 // a template argument list.
2811 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref) << (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(D) ? 1 : 0)
2812 << Template << SS.getRange();
2813 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
2814 return ExprError();
2815 }
2816
2817 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
2818 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
2819 if (!VD) {
2820 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
2821 << D << SS.getRange();
2822 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2823 return ExprError();
2824 }
2825
2826 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
2827 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
2828 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
2829 // that overload resolution actually selects.
2830 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
2831 return ExprError();
2832
2833 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
2834 if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalidDecl)
2835 return ExprError();
2836
2837 // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions. If we got here,
2838 // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this
2839 // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression.
2840 if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
2841 if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember())
2842 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(),
2843 indirectField);
2844
2845 {
2846 QualType type = VD->getType();
2847 ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue;
2848
2849 switch (D->getKind()) {
2850 // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds.
2851 #define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind)
2852 #define VALUE(type, base)
2853 #define DECL(type, base) \
2854 case Decl::type:
2855 #include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc"
2856 llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind");
2857
2858 // These shouldn't make it here.
2859 case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField:
2860 case Decl::ObjCIvar:
2861 llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?");
2862
2863 // Enum constants are always r-values and never references.
2864 // Unresolved using declarations are dependent.
2865 case Decl::EnumConstant:
2866 case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue:
2867 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2868 break;
2869
2870 // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for
2871 // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for
2872 // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really
2873 // exist in the high-level semantics.
2874 case Decl::Field:
2875 case Decl::IndirectField:
2876 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2877 "building reference to field in C?");
2878
2879 // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but
2880 // for internal consistency we do this anyway.
2881 type = type.getNonReferenceType();
2882 valueKind = VK_LValue;
2883 break;
2884
2885 // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values
2886 // depending on the type.
2887 case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: {
2888 if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
2889 type = reftype->getPointeeType();
2890 valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference
2891 break;
2892 }
2893
2894 // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case
2895 // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever.
2896 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2897 type = type.getUnqualifiedType();
2898 break;
2899 }
2900
2901 case Decl::Var:
2902 case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization:
2903 case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization:
2904 // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value.
2905 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2906 !type.hasQualifiers() &&
2907 type->isVoidType()) {
2908 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2909 break;
2910 }
2911 // fallthrough
2912
2913 case Decl::ImplicitParam:
2914 case Decl::ParmVar: {
2915 // These are always l-values.
2916 valueKind = VK_LValue;
2917 type = type.getNonReferenceType();
2918
2919 // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in
2920 // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually
2921 // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no.
2922 if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) {
2923 QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<VarDecl>(VD), Loc);
2924 if (!CapturedType.isNull())
2925 type = CapturedType;
2926 }
2927
2928 break;
2929 }
2930
2931 case Decl::Function: {
2932 if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) {
2933 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BID)) {
2934 type = Context.BuiltinFnTy;
2935 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2936 break;
2937 }
2938 }
2939
2940 const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>();
2941
2942 // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype
2943 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
2944 if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
2945 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
2946 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2947 break;
2948 }
2949
2950 // Functions are l-values in C++.
2951 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2952 valueKind = VK_LValue;
2953 break;
2954 }
2955
2956 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
2957 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
2958 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
2959 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
2960 // type.
2961 if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() &&
2962 isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty))
2963 type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(),
2964 fty->getExtInfo());
2965
2966 // Functions are r-values in C.
2967 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2968 break;
2969 }
2970
2971 case Decl::MSProperty:
2972 valueKind = VK_LValue;
2973 break;
2974
2975 case Decl::CXXMethod:
2976 // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype
2977 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype.
2978 // This should only be possible with a type written directly.
2979 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto
2980 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType()))
2981 if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
2982 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy;
2983 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2984 break;
2985 }
2986
2987 // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static.
2988 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) {
2989 valueKind = VK_LValue;
2990 break;
2991 }
2992 // fallthrough
2993
2994 case Decl::CXXConversion:
2995 case Decl::CXXDestructor:
2996 case Decl::CXXConstructor:
2997 valueKind = VK_RValue;
2998 break;
2999 }
3000
3001 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD,
3002 TemplateArgs);
3003 }
3004 }
3005
ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth,StringRef Source,SmallString<32> & Target)3006 static void ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth, StringRef Source,
3007 SmallString<32> &Target) {
3008 Target.resize(CharByteWidth * (Source.size() + 1));
3009 char *ResultPtr = &Target[0];
3010 const UTF8 *ErrorPtr;
3011 bool success = ConvertUTF8toWide(CharByteWidth, Source, ResultPtr, ErrorPtr);
3012 (void)success;
3013 assert(success);
3014 Target.resize(ResultPtr - &Target[0]);
3015 }
3016
BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT)3017 ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
3018 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT) {
3019 // Pick the current block, lambda, captured statement or function.
3020 Decl *currentDecl = nullptr;
3021 if (const BlockScopeInfo *BSI = getCurBlock())
3022 currentDecl = BSI->TheDecl;
3023 else if (const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda())
3024 currentDecl = LSI->CallOperator;
3025 else if (const CapturedRegionScopeInfo *CSI = getCurCapturedRegion())
3026 currentDecl = CSI->TheCapturedDecl;
3027 else
3028 currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
3029
3030 if (!currentDecl) {
3031 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
3032 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
3033 }
3034
3035 QualType ResTy;
3036 StringLiteral *SL = nullptr;
3037 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext())
3038 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
3039 else {
3040 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of
3041 // the string.
3042 auto Str = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl);
3043 unsigned Length = Str.length();
3044
3045 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
3046 if (IT == PredefinedExpr::LFunction) {
3047 ResTy = Context.WideCharTy.withConst();
3048 SmallString<32> RawChars;
3049 ConvertUTF8ToWideString(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ResTy).getQuantity(),
3050 Str, RawChars);
3051 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal,
3052 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
3053 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, RawChars, StringLiteral::Wide,
3054 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc);
3055 } else {
3056 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
3057 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal,
3058 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0);
3059 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Str, StringLiteral::Ascii,
3060 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc);
3061 }
3062 }
3063
3064 return new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT, SL);
3065 }
3066
ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,tok::TokenKind Kind)3067 ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) {
3068 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
3069
3070 switch (Kind) {
3071 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!");
3072 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
3073 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
3074 case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncDName; break; // [MS]
3075 case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__: IT = PredefinedExpr::FuncSig; break; // [MS]
3076 case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::LFunction; break;
3077 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
3078 }
3079
3080 return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, IT);
3081 }
3082
ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token & Tok,Scope * UDLScope)3083 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) {
3084 SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
3085 bool Invalid = false;
3086 StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
3087 if (Invalid)
3088 return ExprError();
3089
3090 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
3091 PP, Tok.getKind());
3092 if (Literal.hadError())
3093 return ExprError();
3094
3095 QualType Ty;
3096 if (Literal.isWide())
3097 Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++.
3098 else if (Literal.isUTF16())
3099 Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11.
3100 else if (Literal.isUTF32())
3101 Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11.
3102 else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar())
3103 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
3104 else
3105 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
3106
3107 CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii;
3108 if (Literal.isWide())
3109 Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide;
3110 else if (Literal.isUTF16())
3111 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16;
3112 else if (Literal.isUTF32())
3113 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32;
3114
3115 Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty,
3116 Tok.getLocation());
3117
3118 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty())
3119 return Lit;
3120
3121 // We're building a user-defined literal.
3122 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
3123 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
3124 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
3125
3126 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
3127 if (!UDLScope)
3128 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl));
3129
3130 // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form
3131 // operator "" X (ch)
3132 return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc,
3133 Lit, Tok.getLocation());
3134 }
3135
ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc,uint64_t Val)3136 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, uint64_t Val) {
3137 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
3138 return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val),
3139 Context.IntTy, Loc);
3140 }
3141
BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema & S,NumericLiteralParser & Literal,QualType Ty,SourceLocation Loc)3142 static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal,
3143 QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) {
3144 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
3145
3146 using llvm::APFloat;
3147 APFloat Val(Format);
3148
3149 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
3150
3151 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
3152 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
3153 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
3154 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
3155 unsigned diagnostic;
3156 SmallString<20> buffer;
3157 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
3158 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
3159 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
3160 } else {
3161 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
3162 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
3163 }
3164
3165 S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic)
3166 << Ty
3167 << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
3168 }
3169
3170 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
3171 return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc);
3172 }
3173
CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr * E,SourceLocation Loc)3174 bool Sema::CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
3175 assert(E && "Invalid expression");
3176
3177 if (E->isValueDependent())
3178 return false;
3179
3180 QualType QT = E->getType();
3181 if (!QT->isIntegerType() || QT->isBooleanType() || QT->isCharType()) {
3182 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_type) << QT;
3183 return true;
3184 }
3185
3186 llvm::APSInt ValueAPS;
3187 ExprResult R = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, &ValueAPS);
3188
3189 if (R.isInvalid())
3190 return true;
3191
3192 bool ValueIsPositive = ValueAPS.isStrictlyPositive();
3193 if (!ValueIsPositive || ValueAPS.getActiveBits() > 31) {
3194 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_value)
3195 << ValueAPS.toString(10) << ValueIsPositive;
3196 return true;
3197 }
3198
3199 return false;
3200 }
3201
ActOnNumericConstant(const Token & Tok,Scope * UDLScope)3202 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) {
3203 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
3204 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix.
3205 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
3206 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
3207 return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val-'0');
3208 }
3209
3210 SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer;
3211 // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character. Add padding to
3212 // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer. If getSpelling()
3213 // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at
3214 // the EOF, so it is also safe.
3215 SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1);
3216
3217 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
3218 bool Invalid = false;
3219 StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid);
3220 if (Invalid)
3221 return ExprError();
3222
3223 NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(), PP);
3224 if (Literal.hadError)
3225 return ExprError();
3226
3227 if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) {
3228 // We're building a user-defined literal.
3229 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix());
3230 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc =
3231 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset());
3232
3233 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here.
3234 if (!UDLScope)
3235 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl));
3236
3237 QualType CookedTy;
3238 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3239 // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type
3240 // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form
3241 // operator "" X (f L)
3242 CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy;
3243 } else {
3244 // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type
3245 // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form
3246 // operator "" X (n ULL)
3247 CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3248 }
3249
3250 DeclarationName OpName =
3251 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix);
3252 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc);
3253 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc);
3254
3255 SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation();
3256
3257 // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw
3258 // literal or a cooked one.
3259 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
3260 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy,
3261 /*AllowRaw*/true, /*AllowTemplate*/true,
3262 /*AllowStringTemplate*/false)) {
3263 case LOLR_Error:
3264 return ExprError();
3265
3266 case LOLR_Cooked: {
3267 Expr *Lit;
3268 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3269 Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation());
3270 } else {
3271 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0);
3272 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal))
3273 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
3274 << /* Unsigned */ 1;
3275 Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy,
3276 Tok.getLocation());
3277 }
3278 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc);
3279 }
3280
3281 case LOLR_Raw: {
3282 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the
3283 // literal is treated as a call of the form
3284 // operator "" X ("n")
3285 unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset();
3286 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(
3287 Context.CharTy.withConst(), llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1),
3288 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
3289 Expr *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(
3290 Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length), StringLiteral::Ascii,
3291 /*Pascal*/false, StrTy, &TokLoc, 1);
3292 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc);
3293 }
3294
3295 case LOLR_Template: {
3296 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator
3297 // template), L is treated as a call fo the form
3298 // operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>()
3299 // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck.
3300 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs;
3301 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy);
3302 bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType();
3303 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned);
3304 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) {
3305 Value = TokSpelling[I];
3306 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy);
3307 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo;
3308 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo));
3309 }
3310 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, TokLoc,
3311 &ExplicitArgs);
3312 }
3313 case LOLR_StringTemplate:
3314 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result");
3315 }
3316 }
3317
3318 Expr *Res;
3319
3320 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
3321 QualType Ty;
3322 if (Literal.isFloat)
3323 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
3324 else if (!Literal.isLong)
3325 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
3326 else
3327 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
3328
3329 Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
3330
3331 if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) {
3332 if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) {
3333 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
3334 } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
3335 !((getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 120) ||
3336 getOpenCLOptions().cl_khr_fp64)) {
3337 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64);
3338 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
3339 }
3340 }
3341 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
3342 return ExprError();
3343 } else {
3344 QualType Ty;
3345
3346 // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature.
3347 if (!getLangOpts().C99 && Literal.isLongLong) {
3348 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
3349 Diag(Tok.getLocation(),
3350 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ?
3351 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong);
3352 else
3353 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong);
3354 }
3355
3356 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
3357 unsigned MaxWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth();
3358 // The microsoft literal suffix extensions support 128-bit literals, which
3359 // may be wider than [u]intmax_t.
3360 // FIXME: Actually, they don't. We seem to have accidentally invented the
3361 // i128 suffix.
3362 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 128 && MaxWidth < 128 &&
3363 Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type())
3364 MaxWidth = 128;
3365 llvm::APInt ResultVal(MaxWidth, 0);
3366
3367 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
3368 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull.
3369 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large)
3370 << /* Unsigned */ 1;
3371 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3372 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
3373 "long long is not intmax_t?");
3374 } else {
3375 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
3376 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
3377
3378 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
3379 // be an unsigned int.
3380 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
3381
3382 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
3383 unsigned Width = 0;
3384
3385 // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized.
3386 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) {
3387 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger > MaxWidth) {
3388 // If this target doesn't support __int128, error and force to ull.
3389 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_int128_unsupported);
3390 Width = MaxWidth;
3391 Ty = Context.getIntMaxType();
3392 } else if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 8 && !Literal.isUnsigned) {
3393 Width = 8;
3394 Ty = Context.CharTy;
3395 } else {
3396 Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger;
3397 Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width,
3398 /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned);
3399 }
3400 }
3401
3402 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
3403 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
3404 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
3405
3406 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
3407 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
3408 // Does it fit in a signed int?
3409 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
3410 Ty = Context.IntTy;
3411 else if (AllowUnsigned)
3412 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
3413 Width = IntSize;
3414 }
3415 }
3416
3417 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
3418 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
3419 unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth();
3420
3421 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
3422 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
3423 // Does it fit in a signed long?
3424 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
3425 Ty = Context.LongTy;
3426 else if (AllowUnsigned)
3427 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
3428 // Check according to the rules of C90 6.1.3.2p5. C++03 [lex.icon]p2
3429 // is compatible.
3430 else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
3431 const unsigned LongLongSize =
3432 Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
3433 Diag(Tok.getLocation(),
3434 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
3435 ? Literal.isLong
3436 ? diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx
3437 : /*C++98 UB*/ diag::
3438 ext_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx
3439 : diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long)
3440 << (LongLongSize > LongSize ? /*will have type 'long long'*/ 0
3441 : /*will be ill-formed*/ 1);
3442 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
3443 }
3444 Width = LongSize;
3445 }
3446 }
3447
3448 // Check long long if needed.
3449 if (Ty.isNull()) {
3450 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
3451
3452 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
3453 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
3454 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
3455 // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the
3456 // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode.
3457 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 ||
3458 (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && Literal.isLongLong)))
3459 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
3460 else if (AllowUnsigned)
3461 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3462 Width = LongLongSize;
3463 }
3464 }
3465
3466 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
3467 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
3468 if (Ty.isNull()) {
3469 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_integer_literal_too_large_for_signed);
3470 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
3471 Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
3472 }
3473
3474 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
3475 ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width);
3476 }
3477 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
3478 }
3479
3480 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
3481 if (Literal.isImaginary)
3482 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
3483 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
3484
3485 return Res;
3486 }
3487
ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,SourceLocation R,Expr * E)3488 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
3489 assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
3490 return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E);
3491 }
3492
CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema & S,QualType T,SourceLocation Loc,SourceRange ArgRange)3493 static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
3494 SourceLocation Loc,
3495 SourceRange ArgRange) {
3496 // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in
3497 // scalar or vector data type argument..."
3498 // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic
3499 // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void.
3500 if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) {
3501 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type)
3502 << T << ArgRange;
3503 return true;
3504 }
3505
3506 assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) &&
3507 "Scalar types should always be complete");
3508 return false;
3509 }
3510
CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema & S,QualType T,SourceLocation Loc,SourceRange ArgRange,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind)3511 static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
3512 SourceLocation Loc,
3513 SourceRange ArgRange,
3514 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
3515 // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++.
3516 if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus)
3517 return true;
3518
3519 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
3520 if (T->isFunctionType() &&
3521 (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf)) {
3522 // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
3523 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
3524 << TraitKind << ArgRange;
3525 return false;
3526 }
3527
3528 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where
3529 // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k)
3530 if (T->isVoidType()) {
3531 unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type
3532 : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type;
3533 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << TraitKind << ArgRange;
3534 return false;
3535 }
3536
3537 return true;
3538 }
3539
CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema & S,QualType T,SourceLocation Loc,SourceRange ArgRange,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind)3540 static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T,
3541 SourceLocation Loc,
3542 SourceRange ArgRange,
3543 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) {
3544 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the
3545 // runtime doesn't allow it.
3546 if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) {
3547 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
3548 << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf)
3549 << ArgRange;
3550 return true;
3551 }
3552
3553 return false;
3554 }
3555
3556 /// \brief Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed
3557 /// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is.
warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,QualType T,Expr * E)3558 static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T,
3559 Expr *E) {
3560 // Don't warn if the operation changed the type.
3561 if (T != E->getType())
3562 return;
3563
3564 // Now look for array decays.
3565 ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E);
3566 if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay)
3567 return;
3568
3569 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange()
3570 << ICE->getType()
3571 << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType();
3572 }
3573
3574 /// \brief Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression
3575 /// and type traits.
3576 ///
3577 /// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand
3578 /// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify
3579 /// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template
3580 /// instantiation, etc.
CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr * E,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind)3581 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E,
3582 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
3583 QualType ExprTy = E->getType();
3584 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType());
3585
3586 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
3587 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
3588 E->getSourceRange());
3589
3590 // Whitelist some types as extensions
3591 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
3592 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
3593 return false;
3594
3595 // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of
3596 // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to
3597 // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown
3598 // bound).
3599 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) {
3600 if (RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(),
3601 Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()),
3602 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, ExprKind,
3603 E->getSourceRange()))
3604 return true;
3605 } else {
3606 if (RequireCompleteExprType(E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type,
3607 ExprKind, E->getSourceRange()))
3608 return true;
3609 }
3610
3611 // Completing the expression's type may have changed it.
3612 ExprTy = E->getType();
3613 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType());
3614
3615 if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) {
3616 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
3617 << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange();
3618 return true;
3619 }
3620
3621 // The operand for sizeof and alignof is in an unevaluated expression context,
3622 // so side effects could result in unintended consequences.
3623 if ((ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) &&
3624 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() && E->HasSideEffects(Context, false))
3625 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context);
3626
3627 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(),
3628 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind))
3629 return true;
3630
3631 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) {
3632 if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
3633 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) {
3634 QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType();
3635 QualType Type = PVD->getType();
3636 if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) {
3637 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param)
3638 << Type << OType;
3639 Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
3640 }
3641 }
3642 }
3643
3644 // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array
3645 // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most
3646 // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x".
3647 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) {
3648 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(),
3649 BO->getLHS());
3650 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(),
3651 BO->getRHS());
3652 }
3653 }
3654
3655 return false;
3656 }
3657
3658 /// \brief Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type
3659 /// traits.
3660 ///
3661 /// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints
3662 /// on those operands.
3663 ///
3664 /// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
3665 /// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state:
3666 /// Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ...
3667 ///
3668 /// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4
3669 /// The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer
3670 /// standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof.
3671 ///
3672 /// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions.
CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType,SourceLocation OpLoc,SourceRange ExprRange,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind)3673 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType,
3674 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3675 SourceRange ExprRange,
3676 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
3677 if (ExprType->isDependentType())
3678 return false;
3679
3680 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2:
3681 // When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result
3682 // is the size of the referenced type.
3683 // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3:
3684 // When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result
3685 // shall be the alignment of the referenced type.
3686 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
3687 ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
3688
3689 // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3:
3690 // When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result
3691 // is the alignment of the element type.
3692 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign)
3693 ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType);
3694
3695 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep)
3696 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange);
3697
3698 // Whitelist some types as extensions
3699 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
3700 ExprKind))
3701 return false;
3702
3703 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType,
3704 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type,
3705 ExprKind, ExprRange))
3706 return true;
3707
3708 if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) {
3709 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type)
3710 << ExprKind << ExprRange;
3711 return true;
3712 }
3713
3714 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange,
3715 ExprKind))
3716 return true;
3717
3718 return false;
3719 }
3720
CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema & S,Expr * E)3721 static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
3722 E = E->IgnoreParens();
3723
3724 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
3725 if (E->isTypeDependent())
3726 return false;
3727
3728 if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) {
3729 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield)
3730 << 1 << E->getSourceRange();
3731 return true;
3732 }
3733
3734 ValueDecl *D = nullptr;
3735 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
3736 D = DRE->getDecl();
3737 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
3738 D = ME->getMemberDecl();
3739 }
3740
3741 // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a
3742 // complete definition so that we can compute the layout.
3743 //
3744 // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member
3745 // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression
3746 // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member
3747 // in a trailing-return-type.
3748 //
3749 // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC
3750 // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the
3751 // nonsensical answer 0.
3752 //
3753 // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just
3754 // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing
3755 // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of
3756 // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal
3757 // use-case.
3758 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) {
3759 // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a
3760 // definition if we can find a member of it.
3761 if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) {
3762 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type)
3763 << E->getSourceRange();
3764 return true;
3765 }
3766
3767 // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have
3768 // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a
3769 // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to
3770 // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial.
3771 if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType())
3772 return false;
3773 }
3774
3775 return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_AlignOf);
3776 }
3777
CheckVecStepExpr(Expr * E)3778 bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) {
3779 E = E->IgnoreParens();
3780
3781 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
3782 if (E->isTypeDependent())
3783 return false;
3784
3785 return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep);
3786 }
3787
3788 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
3789 ExprResult
CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo * TInfo,SourceLocation OpLoc,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,SourceRange R)3790 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
3791 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3792 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,
3793 SourceRange R) {
3794 if (!TInfo)
3795 return ExprError();
3796
3797 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
3798
3799 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
3800 CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind))
3801 return ExprError();
3802
3803 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
3804 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
3805 ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd());
3806 }
3807
3808 /// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
3809 /// operand.
3810 ExprResult
CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr * E,SourceLocation OpLoc,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind)3811 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
3812 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) {
3813 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
3814 if (PE.isInvalid())
3815 return ExprError();
3816
3817 E = PE.get();
3818
3819 // Verify that the operand is valid.
3820 bool isInvalid = false;
3821 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
3822 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
3823 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf) {
3824 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E);
3825 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) {
3826 isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E);
3827 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign) {
3828 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_openmp_default_simd_align_expr);
3829 isInvalid = true;
3830 } else if (E->refersToBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
3831 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
3832 isInvalid = true;
3833 } else {
3834 isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf);
3835 }
3836
3837 if (isInvalid)
3838 return ExprError();
3839
3840 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf && E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) {
3841 PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E);
3842 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3843 E = PE.get();
3844 }
3845
3846 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
3847 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(
3848 ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
3849 }
3850
3851 /// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c
3852 /// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
3853 /// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
3854 ExprResult
ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc,UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind,bool IsType,void * TyOrEx,const SourceRange & ArgRange)3855 Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc,
3856 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType,
3857 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
3858 // If error parsing type, ignore.
3859 if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError();
3860
3861 if (IsType) {
3862 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3863 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
3864 return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange);
3865 }
3866
3867 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
3868 ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind);
3869 return Result;
3870 }
3871
CheckRealImagOperand(Sema & S,ExprResult & V,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsReal)3872 static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc,
3873 bool IsReal) {
3874 if (V.get()->isTypeDependent())
3875 return S.Context.DependentTy;
3876
3877 // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values.
3878 if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) {
3879 V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get());
3880 if (V.isInvalid())
3881 return QualType();
3882 }
3883
3884 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
3885 if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
3886 return CT->getElementType();
3887
3888 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
3889 if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType())
3890 return V.get()->getType();
3891
3892 // Test for placeholders.
3893 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get());
3894 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
3895 if (PR.get() != V.get()) {
3896 V = PR;
3897 return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal);
3898 }
3899
3900 // Reject anything else.
3901 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType()
3902 << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
3903 return QualType();
3904 }
3905
3906
3907
3908 ExprResult
ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation OpLoc,tok::TokenKind Kind,Expr * Input)3909 Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
3910 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
3911 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
3912 switch (Kind) {
3913 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
3914 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
3915 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
3916 }
3917
3918 // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3919 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input);
3920 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3921 Input = Result.get();
3922
3923 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
3924 }
3925
3926 /// \brief Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal.
3927 ///
3928 /// \return true on error
checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema & S,SourceLocation opLoc,Expr * op)3929 static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S,
3930 SourceLocation opLoc,
3931 Expr *op) {
3932 assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType());
3933 if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() &&
3934 !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime)
3935 return false;
3936
3937 S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
3938 << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3939 << op->getSourceRange();
3940 return true;
3941 }
3942
3943 ExprResult
ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope * S,Expr * base,SourceLocation lbLoc,Expr * idx,SourceLocation rbLoc)3944 Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base, SourceLocation lbLoc,
3945 Expr *idx, SourceLocation rbLoc) {
3946 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
3947 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) {
3948 ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base);
3949 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3950 base = result.get();
3951 }
3952
3953 // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index
3954 // expressions. We can't handle overloads here because the other
3955 // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload
3956 // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack
3957 // at the overload.
3958 if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
3959 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base);
3960 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3961 base = result.get();
3962 }
3963 if (idx->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
3964 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(idx);
3965 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3966 idx = result.get();
3967 }
3968
3969 // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent.
3970 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
3971 (base->isTypeDependent() || idx->isTypeDependent())) {
3972 return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(base, idx, Context.DependentTy,
3973 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc);
3974 }
3975
3976 // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record
3977 // type. The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*,
3978 // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion
3979 // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution
3980 // to do if there aren't any record types involved.
3981 //
3982 // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied
3983 // to overload resolution and so should not take this path.
3984 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
3985 (base->getType()->isRecordType() ||
3986 (!base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
3987 idx->getType()->isRecordType()))) {
3988 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, idx);
3989 }
3990
3991 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, rbLoc);
3992 }
3993
3994 ExprResult
CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr * Base,SourceLocation LLoc,Expr * Idx,SourceLocation RLoc)3995 Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
3996 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
3997 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
3998 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
3999
4000 // Perform default conversions.
4001 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4002 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
4003 if (Result.isInvalid())
4004 return ExprError();
4005 LHSExp = Result.get();
4006 }
4007 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
4008 if (Result.isInvalid())
4009 return ExprError();
4010 RHSExp = Result.get();
4011
4012 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
4013 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue;
4014 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
4015
4016 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
4017 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
4018 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
4019 // and index from the expression types.
4020 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
4021 QualType ResultType;
4022 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
4023 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
4024 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
4025 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
4026 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4027 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
4028 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
4029 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
4030 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
4031 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
4032 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
4033 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
4034
4035 // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript
4036 // expression.
4037 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic())
4038 return BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr, nullptr,
4039 nullptr);
4040
4041 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
4042 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4043 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
4044 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
4045 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
4046 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
4047 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
4048 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
4049 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
4050 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
4051 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
4052 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
4053 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) {
4054 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
4055 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
4056 return ExprError();
4057 }
4058 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4059 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
4060 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
4061 VK = LHSExp->getValueKind();
4062 if (VK != VK_RValue)
4063 OK = OK_VectorComponent;
4064
4065 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
4066 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
4067 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
4068 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
4069 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
4070 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
4071 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
4072 // force the promotion here.
4073 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
4074 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
4075 LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
4076 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
4077 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
4078
4079 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
4080 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
4081 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4082 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
4083 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
4084 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
4085 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
4086 RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
4087 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get();
4088 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
4089
4090 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
4091 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
4092 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4093 } else {
4094 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
4095 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
4096 }
4097 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
4098 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
4099 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
4100 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
4101
4102 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
4103 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
4104 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
4105 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
4106
4107 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
4108 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
4109 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
4110 // incomplete types are not object types.
4111 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
4112 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
4113 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
4114 return ExprError();
4115 }
4116
4117 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4118 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
4119 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type)
4120 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
4121
4122 // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values.
4123 // See IsCForbiddenLValueType.
4124 if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue;
4125 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
4126 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
4127 diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type, BaseExpr))
4128 return ExprError();
4129
4130 assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus ||
4131 !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType());
4132
4133 return new (Context)
4134 ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc);
4135 }
4136
BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,FunctionDecl * FD,ParmVarDecl * Param)4137 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
4138 FunctionDecl *FD,
4139 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
4140 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
4141 Diag(CallLoc,
4142 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
4143 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
4144 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
4145 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
4146 return ExprError();
4147 }
4148
4149 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
4150 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
4151
4152 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext(*this, PotentiallyEvaluated,
4153 Param);
4154
4155 // Instantiate the expression.
4156 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MutiLevelArgList
4157 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, nullptr, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
4158
4159 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param,
4160 MutiLevelArgList.getInnermost());
4161 if (Inst.isInvalid())
4162 return ExprError();
4163
4164 ExprResult Result;
4165 {
4166 // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5:
4167 // The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and
4168 // the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the
4169 // default argument expression appears.
4170 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD);
4171 LocalInstantiationScope Local(*this);
4172 Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, MutiLevelArgList);
4173 }
4174 if (Result.isInvalid())
4175 return ExprError();
4176
4177 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
4178 InitializedEntity Entity
4179 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
4180 InitializationKind Kind
4181 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
4182 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getLocStart());
4183 Expr *ResultE = Result.getAs<Expr>();
4184
4185 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE);
4186 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE);
4187 if (Result.isInvalid())
4188 return ExprError();
4189
4190 Expr *Arg = Result.getAs<Expr>();
4191 CheckCompletedExpr(Arg, Param->getOuterLocStart());
4192 // Build the default argument expression.
4193 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param, Arg);
4194 }
4195
4196 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
4197 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
4198 // be properly destroyed.
4199 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
4200 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
4201 // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because
4202 // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything.
4203 if (isa<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())) {
4204 // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are
4205 // any explicit objects.
4206 ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
4207
4208 // Append all the objects to the cleanup list. Right now, this
4209 // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument
4210 // expressions should never be able to capture anything.
4211 assert(!cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())->getNumObjects() &&
4212 "default argument expression has capturing blocks?");
4213 }
4214
4215 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
4216 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
4217 // as being "referenced".
4218 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg(),
4219 /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true);
4220 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param);
4221 }
4222
4223
4224 Sema::VariadicCallType
getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl * FDecl,const FunctionProtoType * Proto,Expr * Fn)4225 Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4226 Expr *Fn) {
4227 if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) {
4228 if (dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl))
4229 return VariadicConstructor;
4230 else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
4231 return VariadicBlock;
4232 else if (FDecl) {
4233 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
4234 if (Method->isInstance())
4235 return VariadicMethod;
4236 } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy)
4237 return VariadicMethod;
4238 return VariadicFunction;
4239 }
4240 return VariadicDoesNotApply;
4241 }
4242
4243 namespace {
4244 class FunctionCallCCC : public FunctionCallFilterCCC {
4245 public:
FunctionCallCCC(Sema & SemaRef,const IdentifierInfo * FuncName,unsigned NumArgs,MemberExpr * ME)4246 FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName,
4247 unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME)
4248 : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME),
4249 FunctionName(FuncName) {}
4250
ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection & candidate)4251 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
4252 if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() ||
4253 candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) {
4254 return false;
4255 }
4256
4257 return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate);
4258 }
4259
4260 private:
4261 const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName;
4262 };
4263 }
4264
TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema & S,Expr * Fn,FunctionDecl * FDecl,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args)4265 static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn,
4266 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4267 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
4268 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn);
4269 DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName();
4270 SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getLocStart();
4271
4272 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo(
4273 DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName,
4274 S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr,
4275 llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallCCC>(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(),
4276 Args.size(), ME),
4277 Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
4278 if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl()) {
4279 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) {
4280 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
4281 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
4282 for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CD = Corrected.begin(),
4283 CDEnd = Corrected.end();
4284 CD != CDEnd; ++CD) {
4285 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CD))
4286 S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args,
4287 OCS);
4288 }
4289 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) {
4290 case OR_Success:
4291 ND = Best->Function;
4292 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND);
4293 break;
4294 default:
4295 break;
4296 }
4297 }
4298 if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) {
4299 return Corrected;
4300 }
4301 }
4302 }
4303 return TypoCorrection();
4304 }
4305
4306 /// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
4307 /// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
4308 /// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
4309 /// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
4310 /// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
4311 /// true if the call is ill-formed.
4312 bool
ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr * Call,Expr * Fn,FunctionDecl * FDecl,const FunctionProtoType * Proto,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,SourceLocation RParenLoc,bool IsExecConfig)4313 Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
4314 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4315 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4316 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
4317 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
4318 bool IsExecConfig) {
4319 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking.
4320 if (FDecl)
4321 if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
4322 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID))
4323 return false;
4324
4325 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
4326 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
4327 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
4328 bool Invalid = false;
4329 unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams;
4330 unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
4331 ? 1 /* block */
4332 : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */
4333 : 0 /* function */);
4334
4335 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
4336 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
4337 if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
4338 if (Args.size() < MinArgs) {
4339 TypoCorrection TC;
4340 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) {
4341 unsigned diag_id =
4342 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4343 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest
4344 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest;
4345 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << MinArgs
4346 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4347 << TC.getCorrectionRange());
4348 } else if (MinArgs == 1 && FDecl && FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
4349 Diag(RParenLoc,
4350 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4351 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one
4352 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one)
4353 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) << Fn->getSourceRange();
4354 else
4355 Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4356 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args
4357 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least)
4358 << FnKind << MinArgs << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4359 << Fn->getSourceRange();
4360
4361 // Emit the location of the prototype.
4362 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
4363 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl)
4364 << FDecl;
4365
4366 return true;
4367 }
4368 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams);
4369 }
4370
4371 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
4372 // them.
4373 if (Args.size() > NumParams) {
4374 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
4375 TypoCorrection TC;
4376 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) {
4377 unsigned diag_id =
4378 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()
4379 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest
4380 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest;
4381 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << NumParams
4382 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4383 << TC.getCorrectionRange());
4384 } else if (NumParams == 1 && FDecl &&
4385 FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
4386 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4387 MinArgs == NumParams
4388 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one
4389 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one)
4390 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0)
4391 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) << Fn->getSourceRange()
4392 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4393 Args.back()->getLocEnd());
4394 else
4395 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4396 MinArgs == NumParams
4397 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args
4398 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most)
4399 << FnKind << NumParams << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size())
4400 << Fn->getSourceRange()
4401 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getLocStart(),
4402 Args.back()->getLocEnd());
4403
4404 // Emit the location of the prototype.
4405 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig)
4406 Diag(FDecl->getLocStart(), diag::note_callee_decl)
4407 << FDecl;
4408
4409 // This deletes the extra arguments.
4410 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams);
4411 return true;
4412 }
4413 }
4414 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
4415 VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn);
4416
4417 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getLocStart(), FDecl,
4418 Proto, 0, Args, AllArgs, CallType);
4419 if (Invalid)
4420 return true;
4421 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
4422 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
4423 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
4424
4425 return false;
4426 }
4427
GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,FunctionDecl * FDecl,const FunctionProtoType * Proto,unsigned FirstParam,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,SmallVectorImpl<Expr * > & AllArgs,VariadicCallType CallType,bool AllowExplicit,bool IsListInitialization)4428 bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4429 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4430 unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
4431 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs,
4432 VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit,
4433 bool IsListInitialization) {
4434 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
4435 bool Invalid = false;
4436 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
4437 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
4438 for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) {
4439 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i);
4440
4441 Expr *Arg;
4442 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr;
4443 if (ArgIx < Args.size()) {
4444 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
4445
4446 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(),
4447 ProtoArgType,
4448 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg))
4449 return true;
4450
4451 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable.
4452 bool CFAudited = false;
4453 if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy &&
4454 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() &&
4455 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()))
4456 Arg = stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg);
4457 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
4458 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() &&
4459 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>()))
4460 CFAudited = true;
4461
4462 InitializedEntity Entity =
4463 Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param,
4464 ProtoArgType)
4465 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
4466 Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i));
4467
4468 // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API.
4469 if (CFAudited)
4470 Entity.setParameterCFAudited();
4471
4472 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(
4473 Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit);
4474 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4475 return true;
4476
4477 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
4478 } else {
4479 assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee");
4480
4481 ExprResult ArgExpr =
4482 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
4483 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
4484 return true;
4485
4486 Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>();
4487 }
4488
4489 // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This
4490 // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr
4491 // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator.
4492 CheckArrayAccess(Arg);
4493
4494 // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7).
4495 CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg);
4496
4497 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
4498 }
4499
4500 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
4501 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
4502 // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that
4503 // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic.
4504 if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl &&
4505 FDecl->isExternC()) {
4506 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) {
4507 QualType paramType; // ignored
4508 ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, Args[i], paramType);
4509 Invalid |= arg.isInvalid();
4510 AllArgs.push_back(arg.get());
4511 }
4512
4513 // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
4514 } else {
4515 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) {
4516 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], CallType,
4517 FDecl);
4518 Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid();
4519 AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get());
4520 }
4521 }
4522
4523 // Check for array bounds violations.
4524 for (unsigned i = ArgIx, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
4525 CheckArrayAccess(Args[i]);
4526 }
4527 return Invalid;
4528 }
4529
DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema & S,ParmVarDecl * PVD)4530 static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) {
4531 TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc();
4532 if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>())
4533 TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc();
4534 if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>())
4535 S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array)
4536 << ATL.getLocalSourceRange();
4537 }
4538
4539 /// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static
4540 /// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by
4541 /// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large.
4542 ///
4543 /// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of the
4544 /// array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value of the
4545 /// corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first element of
4546 /// an array with at least as many elements as specified by the size expression.
4547 void
CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc,ParmVarDecl * Param,const Expr * ArgExpr)4548 Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc,
4549 ParmVarDecl *Param,
4550 const Expr *ArgExpr) {
4551 // Static array parameters are not supported in C++.
4552 if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4553 return;
4554
4555 QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType();
4556
4557 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy);
4558 if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Static)
4559 return;
4560
4561 if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
4562 Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) {
4563 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange();
4564 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
4565 return;
4566 }
4567
4568 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT);
4569 if (!CAT)
4570 return;
4571
4572 const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT =
4573 Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType());
4574 if (!ArgCAT)
4575 return;
4576
4577 if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) {
4578 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small)
4579 << ArgExpr->getSourceRange()
4580 << (unsigned) ArgCAT->getSize().getZExtValue()
4581 << (unsigned) CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
4582 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param);
4583 }
4584 }
4585
4586 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
4587 /// to have a function type.
4588 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn);
4589
4590 /// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out
4591 /// immediately during argument processing?
isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type)4592 static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) {
4593 // Placeholders are never sugared.
4594 const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type);
4595 if (!placeholder) return false;
4596
4597 switch (placeholder->getKind()) {
4598 // Ignore all the non-placeholder types.
4599 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID)
4600 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID:
4601 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
4602 return false;
4603
4604 // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved
4605 // by the call machinery.
4606 case BuiltinType::Overload:
4607 return false;
4608
4609 // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and
4610 // should be left in place.
4611 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast:
4612 return false;
4613
4614 // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible.
4615 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject:
4616 return true;
4617
4618 // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try
4619 // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types.
4620 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny:
4621 return true;
4622
4623 // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported.
4624 case BuiltinType::BoundMember:
4625 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn:
4626 return true;
4627 }
4628 llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind");
4629 }
4630
4631 /// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to
4632 /// handle later.
checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema & S,MultiExprArg args)4633 static bool checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema &S, MultiExprArg args) {
4634 // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of
4635 // dying at the first failure.
4636 bool hasInvalid = false;
4637 for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) {
4638 if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) {
4639 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]);
4640 if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true;
4641 else args[i] = result.get();
4642 } else if (hasInvalid) {
4643 (void)S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(args[i]);
4644 }
4645 }
4646 return hasInvalid;
4647 }
4648
4649 /// If a builtin function has a pointer argument with no explicit address
4650 /// space, than it should be able to accept a pointer to any address
4651 /// space as input. In order to do this, we need to replace the
4652 /// standard builtin declaration with one that uses the same address space
4653 /// as the call.
4654 ///
4655 /// \returns nullptr If this builtin is not a candidate for a rewrite i.e.
4656 /// it does not contain any pointer arguments without
4657 /// an address space qualifer. Otherwise the rewritten
4658 /// FunctionDecl is returned.
4659 /// TODO: Handle pointer return types.
rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(Sema * Sema,ASTContext & Context,const FunctionDecl * FDecl,MultiExprArg ArgExprs)4660 static FunctionDecl *rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(Sema *Sema, ASTContext &Context,
4661 const FunctionDecl *FDecl,
4662 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) {
4663
4664 QualType DeclType = FDecl->getType();
4665 const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(DeclType);
4666
4667 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.hasPtrArgsOrResult(FDecl->getBuiltinID()) ||
4668 !FT || FT->isVariadic() || ArgExprs.size() != FT->getNumParams())
4669 return nullptr;
4670
4671 bool NeedsNewDecl = false;
4672 unsigned i = 0;
4673 SmallVector<QualType, 8> OverloadParams;
4674
4675 for (QualType ParamType : FT->param_types()) {
4676
4677 // Convert array arguments to pointer to simplify type lookup.
4678 Expr *Arg = Sema->DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ArgExprs[i++]).get();
4679 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType();
4680 if (!ParamType->isPointerType() ||
4681 ParamType.getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace() ||
4682 !ArgType->isPointerType() ||
4683 !ArgType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace()) {
4684 OverloadParams.push_back(ParamType);
4685 continue;
4686 }
4687
4688 NeedsNewDecl = true;
4689 unsigned AS = ArgType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers().getAddressSpace();
4690
4691 QualType PointeeType = ParamType->getPointeeType();
4692 PointeeType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(PointeeType, AS);
4693 OverloadParams.push_back(Context.getPointerType(PointeeType));
4694 }
4695
4696 if (!NeedsNewDecl)
4697 return nullptr;
4698
4699 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
4700 QualType OverloadTy = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(),
4701 OverloadParams, EPI);
4702 DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
4703 FunctionDecl *OverloadDecl = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent,
4704 FDecl->getLocation(),
4705 FDecl->getLocation(),
4706 FDecl->getIdentifier(),
4707 OverloadTy,
4708 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4709 SC_Extern, false,
4710 /*hasPrototype=*/true);
4711 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
4712 FT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OverloadTy);
4713 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
4714 QualType ParamType = FT->getParamType(i);
4715 ParmVarDecl *Parm =
4716 ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, OverloadDecl, SourceLocation(),
4717 SourceLocation(), nullptr, ParamType,
4718 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr);
4719 Parm->setScopeInfo(0, i);
4720 Params.push_back(Parm);
4721 }
4722 OverloadDecl->setParams(Params);
4723 return OverloadDecl;
4724 }
4725
4726 /// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
4727 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
4728 /// locations.
4729 ExprResult
ActOnCallExpr(Scope * S,Expr * Fn,SourceLocation LParenLoc,MultiExprArg ArgExprs,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * ExecConfig,bool IsExecConfig)4730 Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4731 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc,
4732 Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) {
4733 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
4734 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
4735 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4736 Fn = Result.get();
4737
4738 if (checkArgsForPlaceholders(*this, ArgExprs))
4739 return ExprError();
4740
4741 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4742 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
4743 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
4744 if (!ArgExprs.empty()) {
4745 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
4746 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
4747 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
4748 SourceRange(ArgExprs[0]->getLocStart(),
4749 ArgExprs.back()->getLocEnd()));
4750 }
4751
4752 return new (Context)
4753 CallExpr(Context, Fn, None, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4754 }
4755 if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) {
4756 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn);
4757 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4758 Fn = result.get();
4759 }
4760
4761 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
4762 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
4763 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
4764 // Fn.
4765 bool Dependent = false;
4766 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
4767 Dependent = true;
4768 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs))
4769 Dependent = true;
4770
4771 if (Dependent) {
4772 if (ExecConfig) {
4773 return new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(
4774 Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs,
4775 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4776 } else {
4777 return new (Context) CallExpr(
4778 Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4779 }
4780 }
4781
4782 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
4783 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
4784 return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
4785 RParenLoc);
4786
4787 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
4788 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
4789 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4790 Fn = result.get();
4791 }
4792
4793 if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) {
4794 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc);
4795 }
4796 }
4797
4798 // Check for overloaded calls. This can happen even in C due to extensions.
4799 if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) {
4800 OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn);
4801
4802 // We aren't supposed to apply this logic for if there's an '&' involved.
4803 if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) {
4804 OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression;
4805 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl)) {
4806 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl);
4807 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
4808 RParenLoc, ExecConfig);
4809 } else {
4810 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs,
4811 RParenLoc);
4812 }
4813 }
4814 }
4815
4816 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
4817 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
4818 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
4819 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4820 Fn = result.get();
4821 }
4822
4823 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
4824
4825 NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr;
4826 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
4827 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
4828 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
4829
4830 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)) {
4831 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
4832
4833 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
4834 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID()) {
4835 // Rewrite the function decl for this builtin by replacing paramaters
4836 // with no explicit address space with the address space of the arguments
4837 // in ArgExprs.
4838 if ((FDecl = rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(this, Context, FDecl, ArgExprs))) {
4839 NDecl = FDecl;
4840 Fn = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context, FDecl->getQualifierLoc(),
4841 SourceLocation(), FDecl, false,
4842 SourceLocation(), FDecl->getType(),
4843 Fn->getValueKind(), FDecl);
4844 }
4845 }
4846 } else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn))
4847 NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl();
4848
4849 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) {
4850 if (FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>()) {
4851 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(FD, ArgExprs, true)) {
4852 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
4853 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) ?
4854 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call :
4855 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
4856 << FD << FD->getSourceRange();
4857 Diag(FD->getLocation(),
4858 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr)
4859 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
4860 }
4861 }
4862 }
4863
4864 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc,
4865 ExecConfig, IsExecConfig);
4866 }
4867
4868 /// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments.
4869 ///
4870 /// __builtin_astype( value, dst type )
4871 ///
ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr * E,ParsedType ParsedDestTy,SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc)4872 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
4873 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
4874 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
4875 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
4876 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
4877 QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy);
4878 QualType SrcTy = E->getType();
4879 if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4880 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc,
4881 diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size)
4882 << DstTy
4883 << SrcTy
4884 << E->getSourceRange());
4885 return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
4886 }
4887
4888 /// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the
4889 /// provided arguments.
4890 ///
4891 /// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type )
4892 ///
ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr * E,ParsedType ParsedDestTy,SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc)4893 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy,
4894 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
4895 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
4896 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
4897 GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo);
4898 return SemaConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
4899 }
4900
4901 /// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
4902 /// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
4903 /// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
4904 /// block-pointer type.
4905 ///
4906 /// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
4907 ExprResult
BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr * Fn,NamedDecl * NDecl,SourceLocation LParenLoc,ArrayRef<Expr * > Args,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * Config,bool IsExecConfig)4908 Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
4909 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4910 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
4911 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
4912 Expr *Config, bool IsExecConfig) {
4913 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
4914 unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0);
4915
4916 // Promote the function operand.
4917 // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting
4918 // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call.
4919 ExprResult Result;
4920 if (BuiltinID &&
4921 Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) {
4922 Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType()),
4923 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get();
4924 } else {
4925 Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn);
4926 }
4927 if (Result.isInvalid())
4928 return ExprError();
4929 Fn = Result.get();
4930
4931 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
4932 // of arguments and function on error.
4933 CallExpr *TheCall;
4934 if (Config)
4935 TheCall = new (Context) CUDAKernelCallExpr(Context, Fn,
4936 cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args,
4937 Context.BoolTy, VK_RValue,
4938 RParenLoc);
4939 else
4940 TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, Context.BoolTy,
4941 VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
4942
4943 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4944 // C cannot always handle TypoExpr nodes in builtin calls and direct
4945 // function calls as their argument checking don't necessarily handle
4946 // dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have been
4947 // dealt with.
4948 ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(TheCall);
4949 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
4950 TheCall = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(Result.get());
4951 if (!TheCall) return Result;
4952 Args = ArrayRef<Expr *>(TheCall->getArgs(), TheCall->getNumArgs());
4953 }
4954
4955 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking.
4956 if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID))
4957 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall);
4958
4959 retry:
4960 const FunctionType *FuncT;
4961 if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4962 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
4963 // have type pointer to function".
4964 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
4965 if (!FuncT)
4966 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4967 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4968 } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT =
4969 Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4970 FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
4971 } else {
4972 // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type.
4973 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
4974 ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn);
4975 if (rewrite.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4976 Fn = rewrite.get();
4977 TheCall->setCallee(Fn);
4978 goto retry;
4979 }
4980
4981 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4982 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4983 }
4984
4985 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) {
4986 if (Config) {
4987 // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions
4988 if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
4989 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function)
4990 << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4991
4992 // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type
4993 if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType())
4994 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return)
4995 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4996 } else {
4997 // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured
4998 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>())
4999 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config)
5000 << FDecl->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange());
5001 }
5002 }
5003
5004 // Check for a valid return type
5005 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getLocStart(), TheCall,
5006 FDecl))
5007 return ExprError();
5008
5009 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
5010 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
5011 TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType()));
5012
5013 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT);
5014 if (Proto) {
5015 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc,
5016 IsExecConfig))
5017 return ExprError();
5018 } else {
5019 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
5020
5021 if (FDecl) {
5022 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
5023 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
5024 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr;
5025 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) {
5026 Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
5027 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size()))
5028 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
5029 << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
5030 }
5031
5032 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
5033 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
5034 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
5035 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
5036 }
5037
5038 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
5039 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) {
5040 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
5041
5042 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) {
5043 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
5044 Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i));
5045 ExprResult ArgE =
5046 PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg);
5047 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
5048 return true;
5049
5050 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
5051
5052 } else {
5053 ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
5054
5055 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
5056 return true;
5057
5058 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>();
5059 }
5060
5061 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getLocStart(),
5062 Arg->getType(),
5063 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg))
5064 return ExprError();
5065
5066 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
5067 }
5068 }
5069
5070 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
5071 if (!Method->isStatic())
5072 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
5073 << Fn->getSourceRange());
5074
5075 // Check for sentinels
5076 if (NDecl)
5077 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args);
5078
5079 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
5080 if (FDecl) {
5081 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto))
5082 return ExprError();
5083
5084 if (BuiltinID)
5085 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall);
5086 } else if (NDecl) {
5087 if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto))
5088 return ExprError();
5089 } else {
5090 if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto))
5091 return ExprError();
5092 }
5093
5094 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
5095 }
5096
5097 ExprResult
ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc,ParsedType Ty,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * InitExpr)5098 Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
5099 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
5100 assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
5101 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
5102 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
5103
5104 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5105 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
5106 if (!TInfo)
5107 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
5108
5109 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
5110 }
5111
5112 ExprResult
BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc,TypeSourceInfo * TInfo,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * LiteralExpr)5113 Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
5114 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) {
5115 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
5116
5117 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
5118 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
5119 diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type,
5120 SourceRange(LParenLoc,
5121 LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
5122 return ExprError();
5123 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
5124 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
5125 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
5126 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
5127 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
5128 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type,
5129 SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
5130 return ExprError();
5131
5132 InitializedEntity Entity
5133 = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo);
5134 InitializationKind Kind
5135 = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc,
5136 SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
5137 /*InitList=*/true);
5138 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr);
5139 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr,
5140 &literalType);
5141 if (Result.isInvalid())
5142 return ExprError();
5143 LiteralExpr = Result.get();
5144
5145 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == nullptr;
5146 if (isFileScope &&
5147 !LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() &&
5148 !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() &&
5149 !literalType->isDependentType()) { // 6.5.2.5p3
5150 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType))
5151 return ExprError();
5152 }
5153
5154 // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason.
5155 ExprValueKind VK = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue;
5156
5157 return MaybeBindToTemporary(
5158 new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
5159 VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope));
5160 }
5161
5162 ExprResult
ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc,MultiExprArg InitArgList,SourceLocation RBraceLoc)5163 Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList,
5164 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
5165 // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders. Overloads can be
5166 // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't.
5167 for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) {
5168 if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) {
5169 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]);
5170
5171 // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because
5172 // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc.
5173 if (result.isInvalid()) continue;
5174
5175 InitArgList[I] = result.get();
5176 }
5177 }
5178
5179 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
5180 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
5181
5182 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList,
5183 RBraceLoc);
5184 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
5185 return E;
5186 }
5187
5188 /// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC.
maybeExtendBlockObject(ExprResult & E)5189 void Sema::maybeExtendBlockObject(ExprResult &E) {
5190 assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType());
5191 assert(E.get()->isRValue());
5192
5193 // Only do this in an r-value context.
5194 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return;
5195
5196 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, E.get()->getType(),
5197 CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(),
5198 /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_RValue);
5199 ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
5200 }
5201
5202 /// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object
5203 /// pointer type.
PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult & E)5204 CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) {
5205 QualType type = E.get()->getType();
5206 if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
5207 return CK_BitCast;
5208 } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) {
5209 maybeExtendBlockObject(E);
5210 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5211 } else {
5212 assert(type->isPointerType());
5213 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5214 }
5215 }
5216
5217 /// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages
5218 /// except the final cast and returning the kind required.
PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult & Src,QualType DestTy)5219 CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) {
5220 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer.
5221 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with
5222 // pointers. Everything else should be possible.
5223
5224 QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType();
5225 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
5226 return CK_NoOp;
5227
5228 switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5229 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5230 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5231
5232 case Type::STK_CPointer:
5233 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5234 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5235 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5236 case Type::STK_CPointer: {
5237 unsigned SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
5238 unsigned DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
5239 if (SrcAS != DestAS)
5240 return CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
5241 return CK_BitCast;
5242 }
5243 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5244 return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer
5245 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
5246 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5247 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer)
5248 return CK_BitCast;
5249 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer)
5250 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5251 maybeExtendBlockObject(Src);
5252 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
5253 case Type::STK_Bool:
5254 return CK_PointerToBoolean;
5255 case Type::STK_Integral:
5256 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
5257 case Type::STK_Floating:
5258 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5259 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5260 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5261 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer");
5262 }
5263 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5264
5265 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer
5266 case Type::STK_Integral:
5267 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5268 case Type::STK_CPointer:
5269 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5270 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5271 if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5272 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
5273 return CK_NullToPointer;
5274 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
5275 case Type::STK_Bool:
5276 return CK_IntegralToBoolean;
5277 case Type::STK_Integral:
5278 return CK_IntegralCast;
5279 case Type::STK_Floating:
5280 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
5281 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5282 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5283 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5284 CK_IntegralCast);
5285 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
5286 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5287 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5288 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5289 CK_IntegralToFloating);
5290 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
5291 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5292 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5293 }
5294 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5295
5296 case Type::STK_Floating:
5297 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5298 case Type::STK_Floating:
5299 return CK_FloatingCast;
5300 case Type::STK_Bool:
5301 return CK_FloatingToBoolean;
5302 case Type::STK_Integral:
5303 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
5304 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5305 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5306 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5307 CK_FloatingCast);
5308 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
5309 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5310 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5311 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5312 CK_FloatingToIntegral);
5313 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
5314 case Type::STK_CPointer:
5315 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5316 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5317 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?");
5318 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5319 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5320 }
5321 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5322
5323 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5324 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5325 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5326 return CK_FloatingComplexCast;
5327 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5328 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex;
5329 case Type::STK_Floating: {
5330 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
5331 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
5332 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal;
5333 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
5334 return CK_FloatingCast;
5335 }
5336 case Type::STK_Bool:
5337 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean;
5338 case Type::STK_Integral:
5339 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5340 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5341 CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
5342 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
5343 case Type::STK_CPointer:
5344 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5345 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5346 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?");
5347 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5348 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5349 }
5350 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5351
5352 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5353 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) {
5354 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex:
5355 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex;
5356 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex:
5357 return CK_IntegralComplexCast;
5358 case Type::STK_Integral: {
5359 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType();
5360 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy))
5361 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal;
5362 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
5363 return CK_IntegralCast;
5364 }
5365 case Type::STK_Bool:
5366 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean;
5367 case Type::STK_Floating:
5368 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(),
5369 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(),
5370 CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
5371 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
5372 case Type::STK_CPointer:
5373 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer:
5374 case Type::STK_BlockPointer:
5375 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?");
5376 case Type::STK_MemberPointer:
5377 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C");
5378 }
5379 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this");
5380 }
5381
5382 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast");
5383 }
5384
breakDownVectorType(QualType type,uint64_t & len,QualType & eltType)5385 static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len,
5386 QualType &eltType) {
5387 // Vectors are simple.
5388 if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5389 len = vecType->getNumElements();
5390 eltType = vecType->getElementType();
5391 assert(eltType->isScalarType());
5392 return true;
5393 }
5394
5395 // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if
5396 // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types).
5397 if (!type->isRealType()) return false;
5398
5399 len = 1;
5400 eltType = type;
5401 return true;
5402 }
5403
VectorTypesMatch(Sema & S,QualType srcTy,QualType destTy)5404 static bool VectorTypesMatch(Sema &S, QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
5405 uint64_t srcLen, destLen;
5406 QualType srcElt, destElt;
5407 if (!breakDownVectorType(srcTy, srcLen, srcElt)) return false;
5408 if (!breakDownVectorType(destTy, destLen, destElt)) return false;
5409
5410 // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a
5411 // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw
5412 // element size multiplied by the element count.
5413 uint64_t srcEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(srcElt);
5414 uint64_t destEltSize = S.Context.getTypeSize(destElt);
5415
5416 return (srcLen * srcEltSize == destLen * destEltSize);
5417 }
5418
5419 /// Is this a legal conversion between two known vector types?
isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy,QualType destTy)5420 bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) {
5421 assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType());
5422
5423 if (!Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions)
5424 return false;
5425 return VectorTypesMatch(*this, srcTy, destTy);
5426 }
5427
CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R,QualType VectorTy,QualType Ty,CastKind & Kind)5428 bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
5429 CastKind &Kind) {
5430 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
5431
5432 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
5433 if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, Ty, VectorTy))
5434 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
5435 Ty->isVectorType() ?
5436 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
5437 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
5438 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
5439 } else
5440 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
5441 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
5442 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
5443
5444 Kind = CK_BitCast;
5445 return false;
5446 }
5447
CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R,QualType DestTy,Expr * CastExpr,CastKind & Kind)5448 ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy,
5449 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) {
5450 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
5451
5452 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
5453
5454 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
5455 // an ExtVectorType.
5456 // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed.
5457 // (See OpenCL 6.2).
5458 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
5459 if (!VectorTypesMatch(*this, SrcTy, DestTy)
5460 || (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
5461 (DestTy.getCanonicalType() != SrcTy.getCanonicalType()))) {
5462 Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
5463 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
5464 return ExprError();
5465 }
5466 Kind = CK_BitCast;
5467 return CastExpr;
5468 }
5469
5470 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
5471 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
5472 // splat from elt type to vector.
5473 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
5474 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
5475 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
5476 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
5477
5478 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
5479 ExprResult CastExprRes = CastExpr;
5480 CastKind CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy);
5481 if (CastExprRes.isInvalid())
5482 return ExprError();
5483 CastExpr = ImpCastExprToType(CastExprRes.get(), DestElemTy, CK).get();
5484
5485 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
5486 return CastExpr;
5487 }
5488
5489 ExprResult
ActOnCastExpr(Scope * S,SourceLocation LParenLoc,Declarator & D,ParsedType & Ty,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * CastExpr)5490 Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
5491 Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty,
5492 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) {
5493 assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) &&
5494 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
5495
5496 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType());
5497 if (D.isInvalidType())
5498 return ExprError();
5499
5500 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5501 // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only).
5502 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
5503 } else {
5504 // Make sure any TypoExprs have been dealt with.
5505 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CastExpr);
5506 if (!Res.isUsable())
5507 return ExprError();
5508 CastExpr = Res.get();
5509 }
5510
5511 checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D);
5512
5513 QualType castType = castTInfo->getType();
5514 Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo);
5515
5516 bool isVectorLiteral = false;
5517
5518 // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal,
5519 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
5520 ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr);
5521 ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr);
5522 if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().ZVector || getLangOpts().OpenCL)
5523 && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) {
5524 if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
5525 Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
5526 return ExprError();
5527 }
5528 if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
5529 Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0));
5530 if (!E->getType()->isVectorType())
5531 isVectorLiteral = true;
5532 }
5533 else
5534 isVectorLiteral = true;
5535 }
5536
5537 // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
5538 // then handle it as such.
5539 if (isVectorLiteral)
5540 return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo);
5541
5542 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
5543 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
5544 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
5545 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) {
5546 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr);
5547 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
5548 CastExpr = Result.get();
5549 }
5550
5551 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType() &&
5552 !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(LParenLoc))
5553 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange();
5554
5555 CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr);
5556
5557 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr);
5558
5559 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr);
5560 }
5561
BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc,SourceLocation RParenLoc,Expr * E,TypeSourceInfo * TInfo)5562 ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc,
5563 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E,
5564 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
5565 assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) &&
5566 "Expected paren or paren list expression");
5567
5568 Expr **exprs;
5569 unsigned numExprs;
5570 Expr *subExpr;
5571 SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc;
5572 if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) {
5573 LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc();
5574 LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc();
5575 exprs = PE->getExprs();
5576 numExprs = PE->getNumExprs();
5577 } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance
5578 LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen();
5579 LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen();
5580 subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr();
5581 exprs = &subExpr;
5582 numExprs = 1;
5583 }
5584
5585 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
5586 assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type");
5587
5588 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
5589 const VectorType *VTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>();
5590 unsigned numElems = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getNumElements();
5591
5592 // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of
5593 // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector.
5594 // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be
5595 // replicated to all the components of the vector
5596 if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) {
5597 // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the
5598 // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will
5599 // be replicated to all the components of the vector
5600 if (numExprs == 1) {
5601 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType();
5602 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]);
5603 if (Literal.isInvalid())
5604 return ExprError();
5605 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy,
5606 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
5607 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get());
5608 }
5609 else if (numExprs < numElems) {
5610 Diag(E->getExprLoc(),
5611 diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers);
5612 return ExprError();
5613 }
5614 else
5615 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs);
5616 }
5617 else {
5618 // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value,
5619 // it will be replicated to all components of the vector.
5620 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
5621 VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector &&
5622 numExprs == 1) {
5623 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType();
5624 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]);
5625 if (Literal.isInvalid())
5626 return ExprError();
5627 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy,
5628 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy));
5629 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get());
5630 }
5631
5632 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs);
5633 }
5634 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
5635 // braces instead of the original commas.
5636 InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc,
5637 initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc);
5638 initE->setType(Ty);
5639 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE);
5640 }
5641
5642 /// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn
5643 /// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators.
5644 ExprResult
MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope * S,Expr * OrigExpr)5645 Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) {
5646 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr);
5647 if (!E)
5648 return OrigExpr;
5649
5650 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
5651
5652 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
5653 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
5654 E->getExpr(i));
5655
5656 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
5657
5658 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
5659 }
5660
ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,SourceLocation R,MultiExprArg Val)5661 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
5662 SourceLocation R,
5663 MultiExprArg Val) {
5664 Expr *expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, Val, R);
5665 return expr;
5666 }
5667
5668 /// \brief Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer
5669 /// constant and the other is not a pointer. Returns true if a diagnostic is
5670 /// emitted.
DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)5671 bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
5672 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5673 Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr;
5674 Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr;
5675 Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind =
5676 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5677 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
5678
5679 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) {
5680 NullExpr = RHSExpr;
5681 NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr;
5682 NullKind =
5683 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
5684 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull);
5685 }
5686
5687 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull)
5688 return false;
5689
5690 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression)
5691 return false;
5692
5693 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) {
5694 // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL"
5695 // string in the source code.
5696 NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
5697 SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc();
5698 if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL"))
5699 return false;
5700 }
5701
5702 int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr);
5703 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null)
5704 << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType
5705 << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
5706 return true;
5707 }
5708
5709 /// \brief Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise.
checkCondition(Sema & S,Expr * Cond,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)5710 static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5711 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
5712
5713 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition cannot be a floating point type.
5714 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isFloatingType()) {
5715 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat)
5716 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange();
5717 return true;
5718 }
5719
5720 // C99 6.5.15p2
5721 if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false;
5722
5723 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
5724 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange();
5725 return true;
5726 }
5727
5728 /// \brief Handle when one or both operands are void type.
checkConditionalVoidType(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS)5729 static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5730 ExprResult &RHS) {
5731 Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get();
5732 Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get();
5733
5734 if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType())
5735 S.Diag(RHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
5736 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
5737 if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType())
5738 S.Diag(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
5739 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange();
5740 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
5741 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
5742 return S.Context.VoidTy;
5743 }
5744
5745 /// \brief Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy,
5746 /// true otherwise.
checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema & S,ExprResult & NullExpr,QualType PointerTy)5747 static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr,
5748 QualType PointerTy) {
5749 if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) ||
5750 !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context,
5751 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
5752 return true;
5753
5754 NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer);
5755 return false;
5756 }
5757
5758 /// \brief Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting
5759 /// type.
checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc)5760 static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5761 ExprResult &RHS,
5762 SourceLocation Loc) {
5763 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5764 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
5765
5766 if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) {
5767 // Two identical pointers types are always compatible.
5768 return LHSTy;
5769 }
5770
5771 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
5772
5773 // Get the pointee types.
5774 bool IsBlockPointer = false;
5775 if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
5776 lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType();
5777 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5778 IsBlockPointer = true;
5779 } else {
5780 lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5781 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5782 }
5783
5784 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to
5785 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
5786 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite
5787 // type.
5788
5789 // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified
5790 // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should
5791 // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or
5792 // anything.
5793 Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers();
5794 Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers();
5795
5796 unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers();
5797 lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers();
5798 rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers();
5799
5800 lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual);
5801 rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual);
5802
5803 QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(lhptee, rhptee);
5804
5805 if (CompositeTy.isNull()) {
5806 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
5807 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
5808 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5809 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
5810 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
5811 // to get a consistent AST.
5812 QualType incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy);
5813 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5814 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
5815 return incompatTy;
5816 }
5817
5818 // The pointer types are compatible.
5819 QualType ResultTy = CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual);
5820 if (IsBlockPointer)
5821 ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy);
5822 else
5823 ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy);
5824
5825 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast);
5826 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, CK_BitCast);
5827 return ResultTy;
5828 }
5829
5830 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers.
checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc)5831 static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S,
5832 ExprResult &LHS,
5833 ExprResult &RHS,
5834 SourceLocation Loc) {
5835 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5836 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
5837
5838 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
5839 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
5840 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy);
5841 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5842 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5843 return destType;
5844 }
5845 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
5846 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
5847 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5848 return QualType();
5849 }
5850
5851 // We have 2 block pointer types.
5852 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
5853 }
5854
5855 /// \brief Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers.
5856 static QualType
checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc)5857 checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5858 ExprResult &RHS,
5859 SourceLocation Loc) {
5860 // get the pointer types
5861 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
5862 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
5863
5864 // get the "pointed to" types
5865 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5866 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5867
5868 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
5869 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
5870 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
5871 QualType destPointee
5872 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
5873 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5874 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
5875 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
5876 // Promote to void*.
5877 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5878 return destType;
5879 }
5880 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
5881 QualType destPointee
5882 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
5883 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5884 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
5885 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
5886 // Promote to void*.
5887 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
5888 return destType;
5889 }
5890
5891 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc);
5892 }
5893
5894 /// \brief Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second
5895 /// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise.
checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema & S,ExprResult & Int,Expr * PointerExpr,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsIntFirstExpr)5896 static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int,
5897 Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc,
5898 bool IsIntFirstExpr) {
5899 if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() ||
5900 !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType())
5901 return false;
5902
5903 Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr;
5904 Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get();
5905
5906 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
5907 << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType()
5908 << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange();
5909 Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(),
5910 CK_IntegralToPointer);
5911 return true;
5912 }
5913
5914 /// \brief Simple conversion between integer and floating point types.
5915 ///
5916 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the
5917 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar.
5918 ///
5919 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i and s6.11.6 together require that the scalar
5920 /// types are either integer or floating type. Between the two
5921 /// operands, the type with the higher rank is defined as the "result
5922 /// type". The other operand needs to be promoted to the same type. No
5923 /// other type promotion is allowed. We cannot use
5924 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() for this purpose, since it always
5925 /// promotes promotable types.
OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)5926 static QualType OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
5927 ExprResult &RHS,
5928 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5929 LHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
5930 if (LHS.isInvalid())
5931 return QualType();
5932 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
5933 if (RHS.isInvalid())
5934 return QualType();
5935
5936 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
5937 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
5938 QualType LHSType =
5939 S.Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5940 QualType RHSType =
5941 S.Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5942
5943 if (!LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5944 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float)
5945 << LHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5946 return QualType();
5947 }
5948
5949 if (!RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5950 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float)
5951 << RHSType << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
5952 return QualType();
5953 }
5954
5955 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
5956 if (LHSType == RHSType)
5957 return LHSType;
5958
5959 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
5960 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType())
5961 return handleFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType,
5962 /*IsCompAssign = */ false);
5963
5964 // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
5965 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast>
5966 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*IsCompAssign = */ false);
5967 }
5968
5969 /// \brief Convert scalar operands to a vector that matches the
5970 /// condition in length.
5971 ///
5972 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the
5973 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar.
5974 ///
5975 /// We first compute the "result type" for the scalar operands
5976 /// according to OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. Both operands are then converted
5977 /// into a vector of that type where the length matches the condition
5978 /// vector type. s6.11.6 requires that the element types of the result
5979 /// and the condition must have the same number of bits.
5980 static QualType
OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,QualType CondTy,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)5981 OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
5982 QualType CondTy, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
5983 QualType ResTy = OpenCLArithmeticConversions(S, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
5984 if (ResTy.isNull()) return QualType();
5985
5986 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>();
5987 assert(CV);
5988
5989 // Determine the vector result type
5990 unsigned NumElements = CV->getNumElements();
5991 QualType VectorTy = S.Context.getExtVectorType(ResTy, NumElements);
5992
5993 // Ensure that all types have the same number of bits
5994 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CV->getElementType())
5995 != S.Context.getTypeSize(ResTy)) {
5996 // Since VectorTy is created internally, it does not pretty print
5997 // with an OpenCL name. Instead, we just print a description.
5998 std::string EleTyName = ResTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString();
5999 SmallString<64> Str;
6000 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str);
6001 OS << "(vector of " << NumElements << " '" << EleTyName << "' values)";
6002 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size)
6003 << CondTy << OS.str();
6004 return QualType();
6005 }
6006
6007 // Convert operands to the vector result type
6008 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
6009 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
6010
6011 return VectorTy;
6012 }
6013
6014 /// \brief Return false if this is a valid OpenCL condition vector
checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema & S,Expr * Cond,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)6015 static bool checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema &S, Expr *Cond,
6016 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
6017 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 says the elements of the vector must be of
6018 // integral type.
6019 const VectorType *CondTy = Cond->getType()->getAs<VectorType>();
6020 assert(CondTy);
6021 QualType EleTy = CondTy->getElementType();
6022 if (EleTy->isIntegerType()) return false;
6023
6024 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat)
6025 << Cond->getType() << Cond->getSourceRange();
6026 return true;
6027 }
6028
6029 /// \brief Return false if the vector condition type and the vector
6030 /// result type are compatible.
6031 ///
6032 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 requires that both vector types have the same
6033 /// number of elements, and their element types have the same number
6034 /// of bits.
checkVectorResult(Sema & S,QualType CondTy,QualType VecResTy,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)6035 static bool checkVectorResult(Sema &S, QualType CondTy, QualType VecResTy,
6036 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
6037 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>();
6038 const VectorType *RV = VecResTy->getAs<VectorType>();
6039 assert(CV && RV);
6040
6041 if (CV->getNumElements() != RV->getNumElements()) {
6042 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_size)
6043 << CondTy << VecResTy;
6044 return true;
6045 }
6046
6047 QualType CVE = CV->getElementType();
6048 QualType RVE = RV->getElementType();
6049
6050 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CVE) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RVE)) {
6051 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size)
6052 << CondTy << VecResTy;
6053 return true;
6054 }
6055
6056 return false;
6057 }
6058
6059 /// \brief Return the resulting type for the conditional operator in
6060 /// OpenCL (aka "ternary selection operator", OpenCL v1.1
6061 /// s6.3.i) when the condition is a vector type.
6062 static QualType
OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema & S,ExprResult & Cond,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)6063 OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema &S, ExprResult &Cond,
6064 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
6065 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
6066 Cond = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Cond.get());
6067 if (Cond.isInvalid())
6068 return QualType();
6069 QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType();
6070
6071 if (checkOpenCLConditionVector(S, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc))
6072 return QualType();
6073
6074 // If either operand is a vector then find the vector type of the
6075 // result as specified in OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i.
6076 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
6077 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6078 QualType VecResTy = S.CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc,
6079 /*isCompAssign*/false,
6080 /*AllowBothBool*/true,
6081 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
6082 if (VecResTy.isNull()) return QualType();
6083 // The result type must match the condition type as specified in
6084 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6.
6085 if (checkVectorResult(S, CondTy, VecResTy, QuestionLoc))
6086 return QualType();
6087 return VecResTy;
6088 }
6089
6090 // Both operands are scalar.
6091 return OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(S, LHS, RHS, CondTy, QuestionLoc);
6092 }
6093
6094 /// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
6095 /// In that case, LHS = cond.
6096 /// C99 6.5.15
CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult & Cond,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,ExprValueKind & VK,ExprObjectKind & OK,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)6097 QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS,
6098 ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK,
6099 ExprObjectKind &OK,
6100 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
6101
6102 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
6103 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
6104 LHS = LHSResult;
6105
6106 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
6107 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType();
6108 RHS = RHSResult;
6109
6110 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
6111 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
6112 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
6113
6114 VK = VK_RValue;
6115 OK = OK_Ordinary;
6116
6117 // The OpenCL operator with a vector condition is sufficiently
6118 // different to merit its own checker.
6119 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && Cond.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
6120 return OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(*this, Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc);
6121
6122 // First, check the condition.
6123 Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get());
6124 if (Cond.isInvalid())
6125 return QualType();
6126 if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc))
6127 return QualType();
6128
6129 // Now check the two expressions.
6130 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
6131 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
6132 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false,
6133 /*AllowBothBool*/true,
6134 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
6135
6136 QualType ResTy = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
6137 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
6138 return QualType();
6139
6140 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
6141 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
6142
6143 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
6144 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
6145 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
6146 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(LHS, ResTy));
6147 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(RHS, ResTy));
6148
6149 return ResTy;
6150 }
6151
6152 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
6153 // type.
6154 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
6155 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
6156 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
6157 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
6158 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
6159 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
6160 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
6161 }
6162
6163 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
6164 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
6165 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
6166 return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS);
6167 }
6168
6169 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
6170 // the type of the other operand."
6171 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy;
6172 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy;
6173
6174 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
6175 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
6176 QuestionLoc);
6177 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
6178 return QualType();
6179 if (!compositeType.isNull())
6180 return compositeType;
6181
6182
6183 // Handle block pointer types.
6184 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType())
6185 return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
6186 QuestionLoc);
6187
6188 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
6189 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType())
6190 return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS,
6191 QuestionLoc);
6192
6193 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that
6194 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
6195 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
6196 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/true))
6197 return RHSTy;
6198 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
6199 /*isIntFirstExpr=*/false))
6200 return LHSTy;
6201
6202 // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer
6203 // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most
6204 // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression.
6205 if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc))
6206 return QualType();
6207
6208 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
6209 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
6210 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
6211 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6212 return QualType();
6213 }
6214
6215 /// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
6216 /// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation QuestionLoc)6217 QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
6218 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
6219 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
6220 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType();
6221
6222 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
6223 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
6224 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
6225 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
6226 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) {
6227 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6228 return LHSTy;
6229 }
6230 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
6231 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) {
6232 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6233 return RHSTy;
6234 }
6235 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
6236 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
6237 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) {
6238 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6239 return LHSTy;
6240 }
6241 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
6242 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) {
6243 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
6244 return RHSTy;
6245 }
6246 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
6247 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
6248 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) {
6249 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
6250 return LHSTy;
6251 }
6252 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
6253 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) {
6254 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
6255 return RHSTy;
6256 }
6257 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
6258 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6259
6260 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
6261 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
6262 return LHSTy;
6263 }
6264 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6265 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6266 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
6267
6268 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
6269 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
6270 // type. This allows
6271 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
6272 // where B is a subclass of A.
6273 //
6274 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
6275 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
6276 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
6277 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
6278
6279 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
6280 // It could return the composite type.
6281 if (!(compositeType =
6282 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull()) {
6283 // Nothing more to do.
6284 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
6285 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
6286 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
6287 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
6288 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
6289 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
6290 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
6291 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
6292 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
6293 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
6294 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
6295 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
6296 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
6297 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
6298 } else {
6299 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
6300 << LHSTy << RHSTy
6301 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6302 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
6303 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
6304 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
6305 return incompatTy;
6306 }
6307 // The object pointer types are compatible.
6308 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast);
6309 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast);
6310 return compositeType;
6311 }
6312 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
6313 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6314 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
6315 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *',
6316 // so these types are not compatible.
6317 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy
6318 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6319 LHS = RHS = true;
6320 return QualType();
6321 }
6322 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6323 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6324 QualType destPointee
6325 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
6326 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
6327 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
6328 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
6329 // Promote to void*.
6330 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
6331 return destType;
6332 }
6333 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
6334 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
6335 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *',
6336 // so these types are not compatible.
6337 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy
6338 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
6339 LHS = RHS = true;
6340 return QualType();
6341 }
6342 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6343 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6344 QualType destPointee
6345 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
6346 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
6347 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
6348 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp);
6349 // Promote to void*.
6350 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast);
6351 return destType;
6352 }
6353 return QualType();
6354 }
6355
6356 /// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps
6357 /// ParenRange in parentheses.
SuggestParentheses(Sema & Self,SourceLocation Loc,const PartialDiagnostic & Note,SourceRange ParenRange)6358 static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6359 const PartialDiagnostic &Note,
6360 SourceRange ParenRange) {
6361 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd());
6362 if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() &&
6363 EndLoc.isValid()) {
6364 Self.Diag(Loc, Note)
6365 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6366 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
6367 } else {
6368 // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note.
6369 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange;
6370 }
6371 }
6372
IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc)6373 static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
6374 return Opc >= BO_Mul && Opc <= BO_Shr;
6375 }
6376
6377 /// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary
6378 /// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator,
6379 /// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side
6380 /// expression.
IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr * E,BinaryOperatorKind * Opcode,Expr ** RHSExprs)6381 static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode,
6382 Expr **RHSExprs) {
6383 // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis.
6384 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
6385 E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator();
6386 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts();
6387
6388 // Built-in binary operator.
6389 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
6390 if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) {
6391 *Opcode = OP->getOpcode();
6392 *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS();
6393 return true;
6394 }
6395 }
6396
6397 // Overloaded operator.
6398 if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
6399 if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2)
6400 return false;
6401
6402 // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into
6403 // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op.
6404 OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator();
6405 if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow ||
6406 OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus)
6407 return false;
6408
6409 BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO);
6410 if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) {
6411 *Opcode = OpKind;
6412 *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1);
6413 return true;
6414 }
6415 }
6416
6417 return false;
6418 }
6419
IsLogicOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc)6420 static bool IsLogicOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) {
6421 return (Opc >= BO_LT && Opc <= BO_NE) || (Opc >= BO_LAnd && Opc <= BO_LOr);
6422 }
6423
6424 /// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type
6425 /// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is
6426 /// commonly interpreted as boolean.
ExprLooksBoolean(Expr * E)6427 static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) {
6428 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
6429
6430 if (E->getType()->isBooleanType())
6431 return true;
6432 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
6433 return IsLogicOp(OP->getOpcode());
6434 if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E))
6435 return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot;
6436 if (E->getType()->isPointerType())
6437 return true;
6438
6439 return false;
6440 }
6441
6442 /// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator
6443 /// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed
6444 /// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example:
6445 /// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2".
DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema & Self,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * Condition,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)6446 static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self,
6447 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6448 Expr *Condition,
6449 Expr *LHSExpr,
6450 Expr *RHSExpr) {
6451 BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode;
6452 Expr *CondRHS;
6453
6454 if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS))
6455 return;
6456 if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS))
6457 return;
6458
6459 // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right-
6460 // hand side that looks boolean, so warn.
6461
6462 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_conditional)
6463 << Condition->getSourceRange()
6464 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode);
6465
6466 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
6467 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
6468 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode),
6469 SourceRange(Condition->getLocStart(), Condition->getLocEnd()));
6470
6471 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
6472 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first),
6473 SourceRange(CondRHS->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd()));
6474 }
6475
6476 /// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
6477 /// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,SourceLocation ColonLoc,Expr * CondExpr,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)6478 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
6479 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
6480 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
6481 Expr *RHSExpr) {
6482 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6483 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes in the condition because it
6484 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
6485 // been dealt with before checking the operands.
6486 ExprResult CondResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CondExpr);
6487 if (!CondResult.isUsable()) return ExprError();
6488 CondExpr = CondResult.get();
6489 }
6490
6491 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
6492 // was the condition.
6493 OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr;
6494 Expr *commonExpr = nullptr;
6495 if (!LHSExpr) {
6496 commonExpr = CondExpr;
6497 // Lower out placeholder types first. This is important so that we don't
6498 // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such
6499 // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax.
6500 if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) {
6501 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr);
6502 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
6503 commonExpr = result.get();
6504 }
6505 // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except
6506 // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional.
6507 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
6508 && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent()
6509 && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind()
6510 && commonExpr->isGLValue()
6511 && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
6512 && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject()
6513 && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) {
6514 ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr);
6515 if (commonRes.isInvalid())
6516 return ExprError();
6517 commonExpr = commonRes.get();
6518 }
6519
6520 opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(),
6521 commonExpr->getType(),
6522 commonExpr->getValueKind(),
6523 commonExpr->getObjectKind(),
6524 commonExpr);
6525 LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue;
6526 }
6527
6528 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
6529 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
6530 ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
6531 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS,
6532 VK, OK, QuestionLoc);
6533 if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() ||
6534 RHS.isInvalid())
6535 return ExprError();
6536
6537 DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(),
6538 RHS.get());
6539
6540 CheckBoolLikeConversion(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc);
6541
6542 if (!commonExpr)
6543 return new (Context)
6544 ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc,
6545 RHS.get(), result, VK, OK);
6546
6547 return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator(
6548 commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc,
6549 ColonLoc, result, VK, OK);
6550 }
6551
6552 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
6553 // being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
6554 // routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
6555 // This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
6556 // FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
6557 static Sema::AssignConvertType
checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema & S,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType)6558 checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) {
6559 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
6560 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
6561
6562 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
6563 const Type *lhptee, *rhptee;
6564 Qualifiers lhq, rhq;
6565 std::tie(lhptee, lhq) =
6566 cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
6567 std::tie(rhptee, rhq) =
6568 cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair();
6569
6570 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible;
6571
6572 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
6573 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
6574 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
6575
6576 // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay.
6577 if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() &&
6578 lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) {
6579 // Ignore lifetime for further calculation.
6580 lhq.removeObjCLifetime();
6581 rhq.removeObjCLifetime();
6582 }
6583
6584 if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) {
6585 // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal. TODO: address subspaces
6586 if (!lhq.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhq))
6587 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6588
6589 // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to
6590 // and from void*.
6591 else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime()
6592 .compatiblyIncludes(
6593 rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime())
6594 && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType()))
6595 ; // keep old
6596
6597 // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal.
6598 else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime())
6599 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6600
6601 // For GCC compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated
6602 // as still compatible in C.
6603 else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6604 }
6605
6606 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
6607 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
6608 // version of void...
6609 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
6610 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
6611 return ConvTy;
6612
6613 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
6614 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
6615 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer;
6616 }
6617
6618 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
6619 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
6620 return ConvTy;
6621
6622 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
6623 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
6624 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer;
6625 }
6626
6627 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
6628 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
6629 QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0);
6630 if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) {
6631 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
6632 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
6633 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
6634 if (lhptee->isCharType())
6635 ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
6636 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
6637 ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans);
6638
6639 if (rhptee->isCharType())
6640 rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy;
6641 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
6642 rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans);
6643
6644 if (ltrans == rtrans) {
6645 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
6646 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
6647 // warning can be disabled.
6648 if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible)
6649 return ConvTy;
6650
6651 return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign;
6652 }
6653
6654 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
6655 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
6656 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
6657 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
6658 if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) {
6659 do {
6660 lhptee = cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr();
6661 rhptee = cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().getTypePtr();
6662 } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee));
6663
6664 if (lhptee == rhptee)
6665 return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
6666 }
6667
6668 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
6669 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6670 }
6671 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
6672 S.IsNoReturnConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans))
6673 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6674 return ConvTy;
6675 }
6676
6677 /// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
6678 /// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
6679 /// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
6680 // types.
6681 static Sema::AssignConvertType
checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema & S,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType)6682 checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
6683 QualType RHSType) {
6684 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!");
6685 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!");
6686
6687 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
6688
6689 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
6690 lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType();
6691 rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType();
6692
6693 // In C++, the types have to match exactly.
6694 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
6695 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
6696
6697 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible;
6698
6699 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
6700 if (lhptee.getLocalQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalQualifiers())
6701 ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6702
6703 if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
6704 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer;
6705
6706 return ConvTy;
6707 }
6708
6709 /// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
6710 /// for assignment compatibility.
6711 static Sema::AssignConvertType
checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema & S,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType)6712 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType,
6713 QualType RHSType) {
6714 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!");
6715 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!");
6716
6717 if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6718 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
6719 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
6720 !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
6721 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6722 return Sema::Compatible;
6723 }
6724 if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6725 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
6726 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
6727 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6728 return Sema::Compatible;
6729 }
6730 QualType lhptee = LHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6731 QualType rhptee = RHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6732
6733 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee) &&
6734 // make an exception for id<P>
6735 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
6736 return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
6737
6738 if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType))
6739 return Sema::Compatible;
6740 if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
6741 return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
6742 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer;
6743 }
6744
6745 Sema::AssignConvertType
CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc,QualType LHSType,QualType RHSType)6746 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc,
6747 QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) {
6748 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what
6749 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints
6750 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't
6751 // usually happen on valid code.
6752 OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue);
6753 ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr;
6754 CastKind K = CK_Invalid;
6755
6756 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K);
6757 }
6758
6759 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
6760 /// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
6761 /// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
6762 ///
6763 /// int a, *pint;
6764 /// short *pshort;
6765 /// struct foo *pfoo;
6766 ///
6767 /// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
6768 /// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
6769 /// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
6770 /// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
6771 ///
6772 /// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
6773 /// C99 spec dictates.
6774 ///
6775 /// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible.
6776 Sema::AssignConvertType
CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType,ExprResult & RHS,CastKind & Kind)6777 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS,
6778 CastKind &Kind) {
6779 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
6780 QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType;
6781
6782 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
6783 // them.
6784 LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
6785 RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType();
6786
6787 // Common case: no conversion required.
6788 if (LHSType == RHSType) {
6789 Kind = CK_NoOp;
6790 return Compatible;
6791 }
6792
6793 // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an
6794 // atomic qualification step.
6795 if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) {
6796 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
6797 CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind);
6798 if (result != Compatible)
6799 return result;
6800 if (Kind != CK_NoOp)
6801 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind);
6802 Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic;
6803 return Compatible;
6804 }
6805
6806 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
6807 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
6808 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
6809 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
6810 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
6811 // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
6812 // type.
6813 if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6814 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) {
6815 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast;
6816 return Compatible;
6817 }
6818 return Incompatible;
6819 }
6820
6821 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
6822 // to the same ExtVector type.
6823 if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) {
6824 if (RHSType->isExtVectorType())
6825 return Incompatible;
6826 if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) {
6827 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the
6828 // element type.
6829 QualType elType = cast<ExtVectorType>(LHSType)->getElementType();
6830 if (elType != RHSType) {
6831 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, elType);
6832 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), elType, Kind);
6833 }
6834 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
6835 return Compatible;
6836 }
6837 }
6838
6839 // Conversions to or from vector type.
6840 if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) {
6841 if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) {
6842 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
6843 // vector type and vice versa
6844 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
6845 Kind = CK_BitCast;
6846 return Compatible;
6847 }
6848
6849 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
6850 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
6851 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
6852 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) {
6853 Kind = CK_BitCast;
6854 return IncompatibleVectors;
6855 }
6856 }
6857 return Incompatible;
6858 }
6859
6860 // Arithmetic conversions.
6861 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() &&
6862 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) {
6863 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType);
6864 return Compatible;
6865 }
6866
6867 // Conversions to normal pointers.
6868 if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) {
6869 // U* -> T*
6870 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
6871 unsigned AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
6872 unsigned AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace();
6873 Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast;
6874 return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
6875 }
6876
6877 // int -> T*
6878 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6879 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null?
6880 return IntToPointer;
6881 }
6882
6883 // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
6884 // with two exceptions:
6885 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
6886 // - conversions to void*
6887 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
6888 Kind = CK_BitCast;
6889 return Compatible;
6890 }
6891
6892 // - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type
6893 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
6894 Context.hasSameType(LHSType,
6895 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
6896 Kind = CK_BitCast;
6897 return Compatible;
6898 }
6899
6900 Kind = CK_BitCast;
6901 return IncompatiblePointer;
6902 }
6903
6904 // U^ -> void*
6905 if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
6906 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
6907 Kind = CK_BitCast;
6908 return Compatible;
6909 }
6910 }
6911
6912 return Incompatible;
6913 }
6914
6915 // Conversions to block pointers.
6916 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) {
6917 // U^ -> T^
6918 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
6919 Kind = CK_BitCast;
6920 return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
6921 }
6922
6923 // int or null -> T^
6924 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6925 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
6926 return IntToBlockPointer;
6927 }
6928
6929 // id -> T^
6930 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) {
6931 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
6932 return Compatible;
6933 }
6934
6935 // void* -> T^
6936 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())
6937 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
6938 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
6939 return Compatible;
6940 }
6941
6942 return Incompatible;
6943 }
6944
6945 // Conversions to Objective-C pointers.
6946 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) {
6947 // A* -> B*
6948 if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
6949 Kind = CK_BitCast;
6950 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
6951 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType);
6952 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6953 result == Compatible &&
6954 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType))
6955 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
6956 return result;
6957 }
6958
6959 // int or null -> A*
6960 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
6961 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null
6962 return IntToPointer;
6963 }
6964
6965 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers,
6966 // with two exceptions:
6967 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
6968 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
6969
6970 // - conversions from 'void*'
6971 if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) {
6972 return Compatible;
6973 }
6974
6975 // - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type
6976 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() &&
6977 Context.hasSameType(RHSType,
6978 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) {
6979 return Compatible;
6980 }
6981
6982 return IncompatiblePointer;
6983 }
6984
6985 // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer.
6986 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
6987 LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) {
6988 maybeExtendBlockObject(RHS);
6989 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
6990 return Compatible;
6991 }
6992
6993 return Incompatible;
6994 }
6995
6996 // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above.
6997 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) {
6998 // T* -> _Bool
6999 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
7000 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
7001 return Compatible;
7002 }
7003
7004 // T* -> int
7005 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
7006 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
7007 return PointerToInt;
7008 }
7009
7010 return Incompatible;
7011 }
7012
7013 // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above.
7014 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) {
7015 // T* -> _Bool
7016 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) {
7017 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean;
7018 return Compatible;
7019 }
7020
7021 // T* -> int
7022 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) {
7023 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral;
7024 return PointerToInt;
7025 }
7026
7027 return Incompatible;
7028 }
7029
7030 // struct A -> struct B
7031 if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) {
7032 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
7033 Kind = CK_NoOp;
7034 return Compatible;
7035 }
7036 }
7037
7038 return Incompatible;
7039 }
7040
7041 /// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
7042 /// used to initialize the transparent union.
ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema & S,ASTContext & C,ExprResult & EResult,QualType UnionType,FieldDecl * Field)7043 static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C,
7044 ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType,
7045 FieldDecl *Field) {
7046 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
7047 // of the transparent union.
7048 Expr *E = EResult.get();
7049 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
7050 E, SourceLocation());
7051 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
7052 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
7053
7054 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
7055 // union type from this initializer list.
7056 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
7057 EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
7058 VK_RValue, Initializer, false);
7059 }
7060
7061 Sema::AssignConvertType
CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType,ExprResult & RHS)7062 Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType,
7063 ExprResult &RHS) {
7064 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
7065
7066 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
7067 // transparent_union GCC extension.
7068 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
7069 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
7070 return Incompatible;
7071
7072 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
7073 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
7074 FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr;
7075 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
7076 for (auto *it : UD->fields()) {
7077 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
7078 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
7079 // 1) void pointer
7080 // 2) null pointer constant
7081 if (RHSType->isPointerType())
7082 if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
7083 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
7084 InitField = it;
7085 break;
7086 }
7087
7088 if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
7089 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
7090 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(),
7091 CK_NullToPointer);
7092 InitField = it;
7093 break;
7094 }
7095 }
7096
7097 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
7098 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind)
7099 == Compatible) {
7100 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind);
7101 InitField = it;
7102 break;
7103 }
7104 }
7105
7106 if (!InitField)
7107 return Incompatible;
7108
7109 ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField);
7110 return Compatible;
7111 }
7112
7113 Sema::AssignConvertType
CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType,ExprResult & RHS,bool Diagnose,bool DiagnoseCFAudited)7114 Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS,
7115 bool Diagnose,
7116 bool DiagnoseCFAudited) {
7117 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7118 if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) {
7119 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
7120 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
7121 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
7122 ExprResult Res;
7123 if (Diagnose) {
7124 Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
7125 AA_Assigning);
7126 } else {
7127 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
7128 TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
7129 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
7130 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
7131 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7132 /*CStyle=*/false,
7133 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
7134 if (ICS.isFailure())
7135 return Incompatible;
7136 Res = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(),
7137 ICS, AA_Assigning);
7138 }
7139 if (Res.isInvalid())
7140 return Incompatible;
7141 Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible;
7142 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
7143 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType,
7144 RHS.get()->getType()))
7145 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef;
7146 RHS = Res;
7147 return result;
7148 }
7149
7150 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
7151 // structures.
7152 // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should
7153 // happen there, though.
7154 }
7155
7156 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
7157 // a null pointer constant.
7158 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
7159 LHSType->isBlockPointerType()) &&
7160 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
7161 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
7162 CastKind Kind;
7163 CXXCastPath Path;
7164 CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path, false);
7165 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_RValue, &Path);
7166 return Compatible;
7167 }
7168
7169 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
7170 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
7171 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
7172 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
7173 //
7174 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
7175 if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) {
7176 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
7177 if (RHS.isInvalid())
7178 return Incompatible;
7179 }
7180
7181 Expr *PRE = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts();
7182 if (ObjCProtocolExpr *OPE = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolExpr>(PRE)) {
7183 ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = OPE->getProtocol();
7184 if (PDecl && !PDecl->hasDefinition()) {
7185 Diag(PRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_atprotocol_protocol) << PDecl->getName();
7186 Diag(PDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PDecl;
7187 }
7188 }
7189
7190 CastKind Kind = CK_Invalid;
7191 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
7192 CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind);
7193
7194 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
7195 // type of the assignment expression.
7196 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
7197 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
7198 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
7199 // does not have reference type.
7200 if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) {
7201 QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7202 Expr *E = RHS.get();
7203 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
7204 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion,
7205 DiagnoseCFAudited);
7206 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1 &&
7207 (CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getLocStart(),
7208 LHSType, E->getType(), E) ||
7209 ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(LHSType, E))) {
7210 RHS = E;
7211 return Compatible;
7212 }
7213
7214 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind);
7215 }
7216 return result;
7217 }
7218
InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS)7219 QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS,
7220 ExprResult &RHS) {
7221 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
7222 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
7223 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7224 return QualType();
7225 }
7226
7227 /// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting
7228 /// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat.
7229 /// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar
7230 /// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except
7231 /// for float->int.
7232 ///
7233 /// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions
7234 /// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure)
tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema & S,ExprResult * scalar,QualType scalarTy,QualType vectorEltTy,QualType vectorTy)7235 static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar,
7236 QualType scalarTy,
7237 QualType vectorEltTy,
7238 QualType vectorTy) {
7239 // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it,
7240 // if necessary.
7241 CastKind scalarCast = CK_Invalid;
7242
7243 if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
7244 if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context))
7245 return true;
7246 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
7247 S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0)
7248 return true;
7249 scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast;
7250 } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
7251 if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
7252 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
7253 S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0)
7254 return true;
7255 scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast;
7256 }
7257 else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context))
7258 scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating;
7259 else
7260 return true;
7261 } else {
7262 return true;
7263 }
7264
7265 // Adjust scalar if desired.
7266 if (scalar) {
7267 if (scalarCast != CK_Invalid)
7268 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast);
7269 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat);
7270 }
7271 return false;
7272 }
7273
CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign,bool AllowBothBool,bool AllowBoolConversions)7274 QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7275 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign,
7276 bool AllowBothBool,
7277 bool AllowBoolConversions) {
7278 if (!IsCompAssign) {
7279 LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get());
7280 if (LHS.isInvalid())
7281 return QualType();
7282 }
7283 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
7284 if (RHS.isInvalid())
7285 return QualType();
7286
7287 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
7288 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
7289 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7290 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7291
7292 const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
7293 const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
7294 assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType);
7295
7296 // AltiVec-style "vector bool op vector bool" combinations are allowed
7297 // for some operators but not others.
7298 if (!AllowBothBool &&
7299 LHSVecType && LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
7300 RHSVecType && RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool)
7301 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7302
7303 // If the vector types are identical, return.
7304 if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType))
7305 return LHSType;
7306
7307 // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type.
7308 if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType &&
7309 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) {
7310 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
7311 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
7312 return LHSType;
7313 }
7314
7315 if (!IsCompAssign)
7316 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
7317 return RHSType;
7318 }
7319
7320 // AllowBoolConversions says that bool and non-bool AltiVec vectors
7321 // can be mixed, with the result being the non-bool type. The non-bool
7322 // operand must have integer element type.
7323 if (AllowBoolConversions && LHSVecType && RHSVecType &&
7324 LHSVecType->getNumElements() == RHSVecType->getNumElements() &&
7325 (Context.getTypeSize(LHSVecType->getElementType()) ==
7326 Context.getTypeSize(RHSVecType->getElementType()))) {
7327 if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector &&
7328 LHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType() &&
7329 RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) {
7330 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
7331 return LHSType;
7332 }
7333 if (!IsCompAssign &&
7334 LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
7335 RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector &&
7336 RHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) {
7337 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
7338 return RHSType;
7339 }
7340 }
7341
7342 // If there's an ext-vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to
7343 // the vector element type and splat.
7344 if (!RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) {
7345 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType,
7346 LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType))
7347 return LHSType;
7348 }
7349 if (!LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) {
7350 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS),
7351 LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(),
7352 RHSType))
7353 return RHSType;
7354 }
7355
7356 // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size
7357 // needs to be the same.
7358 // FIXME: Should we really be allowing this?
7359 // FIXME: We really just pick the LHS type arbitrarily?
7360 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) {
7361 QualType resultType = LHSType;
7362 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), resultType, CK_BitCast);
7363 return resultType;
7364 }
7365
7366 // Okay, the expression is invalid.
7367
7368 // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that.
7369 if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) ||
7370 (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) {
7371 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar)
7372 << LHSType << RHSType
7373 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7374 return QualType();
7375 }
7376
7377 // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic.
7378 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
7379 << LHSType << RHSType
7380 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7381 return QualType();
7382 }
7383
7384 // checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an
7385 // expression. These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an
7386 // integer instead of a pointer.
checkArithmeticNull(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompare)7387 static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7388 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) {
7389 // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant,
7390 // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively
7391 // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow.
7392 bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
7393 bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
7394
7395 QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType();
7396
7397 // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and
7398 // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about.
7399 if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() ||
7400 NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType())
7401 return;
7402
7403 // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter
7404 // what the other expression is.
7405 if (!IsCompare) {
7406 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation)
7407 << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7408 << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
7409 return;
7410 }
7411
7412 // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer
7413 // if the other expression is a pointer.
7414 if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() ||
7415 NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType())
7416 return;
7417
7418 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation)
7419 << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType
7420 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7421 }
7422
CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign,bool IsDiv)7423 QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7424 SourceLocation Loc,
7425 bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) {
7426 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7427
7428 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7429 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
7430 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
7431 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec,
7432 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
7433
7434 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign);
7435 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7436 return QualType();
7437
7438
7439 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType())
7440 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7441
7442 // Check for division by zero.
7443 llvm::APSInt RHSValue;
7444 if (IsDiv && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
7445 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0)
7446 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7447 PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
7448 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7449
7450 return compType;
7451 }
7452
CheckRemainderOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign)7453 QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
7454 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
7455 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7456
7457 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7458 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7459 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
7460 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7461 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
7462 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec,
7463 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
7464 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7465 }
7466
7467 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign);
7468 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7469 return QualType();
7470
7471 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isIntegerType())
7472 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7473
7474 // Check for remainder by zero.
7475 llvm::APSInt RHSValue;
7476 if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
7477 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, Context) && RHSValue == 0)
7478 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7479 PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
7480 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7481
7482 return compType;
7483 }
7484
7485 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers.
diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)7486 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7487 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7488 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7489 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
7490 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
7491 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
7492 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
7493 }
7494
7495 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer.
diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * Pointer)7496 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7497 Expr *Pointer) {
7498 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7499 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type
7500 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
7501 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange();
7502 }
7503
7504 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers.
diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * LHS,Expr * RHS)7505 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7506 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
7507 assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7508 assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7509 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7510 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
7511 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
7512 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
7513 // We only show the second type if it differs from the first.
7514 << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(),
7515 RHS->getType())
7516 << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType()
7517 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
7518 }
7519
7520 /// \brief Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer.
diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * Pointer)7521 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7522 Expr *Pointer) {
7523 assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7524 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
7525 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type
7526 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
7527 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType()
7528 << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */
7529 << Pointer->getSourceRange();
7530 }
7531
7532 /// \brief Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type
7533 ///
7534 /// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type
checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * Operand)7535 static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7536 Expr *Operand) {
7537 QualType ResType = Operand->getType();
7538 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
7539 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
7540
7541 assert(ResType->isAnyPointerType() && !ResType->isDependentType());
7542 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
7543 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
7544 diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type,
7545 PointeeTy, Operand->getSourceRange());
7546 }
7547
7548 /// \brief Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand.
7549 ///
7550 /// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types
7551 /// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed
7552 /// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an
7553 /// extension.
7554 ///
7555 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * Operand)7556 static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7557 Expr *Operand) {
7558 QualType ResType = Operand->getType();
7559 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
7560 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
7561
7562 if (!ResType->isAnyPointerType()) return true;
7563
7564 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
7565 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
7566 diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
7567 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7568 }
7569 if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
7570 diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand);
7571 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7572 }
7573
7574 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false;
7575
7576 return true;
7577 }
7578
7579 /// \brief Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer
7580 /// operands.
7581 ///
7582 /// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much
7583 /// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic
7584 /// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS
7585 /// are (potentially problematic) pointers.
7586 ///
7587 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension).
checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)7588 static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7589 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7590 bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
7591 bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType();
7592 if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true;
7593
7594 QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy;
7595 if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
7596 if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType();
7597
7598 // if both are pointers check if operation is valid wrt address spaces
7599 if (isLHSPointer && isRHSPointer) {
7600 const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
7601 const PointerType *rhsPtr = RHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
7602 if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*rhsPtr)) {
7603 S.Diag(Loc,
7604 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
7605 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << 1 /*arithmetic op*/
7606 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
7607 return false;
7608 }
7609 }
7610
7611 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
7612 bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
7613 bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType();
7614 if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) {
7615 if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
7616 else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr);
7617 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
7618
7619 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7620 }
7621
7622 bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
7623 bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType();
7624 if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) {
7625 if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr);
7626 else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc,
7627 RHSExpr);
7628 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
7629
7630 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
7631 }
7632
7633 if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr))
7634 return false;
7635 if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr))
7636 return false;
7637
7638 return true;
7639 }
7640
7641 /// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string
7642 /// literal.
diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema & Self,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)7643 static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7644 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7645 StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7646 Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr;
7647 if (!StrExpr) {
7648 StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7649 IndexExpr = LHSExpr;
7650 }
7651
7652 bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr &&
7653 IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
7654 if (!IsStringPlusInt || IndexExpr->isValueDependent())
7655 return;
7656
7657 llvm::APSInt index;
7658 if (IndexExpr->EvaluateAsInt(index, Self.getASTContext())) {
7659 unsigned StrLenWithNull = StrExpr->getLength() + 1;
7660 if (index.isNonNegative() &&
7661 index <= llvm::APSInt(llvm::APInt(index.getBitWidth(), StrLenWithNull),
7662 index.isUnsigned()))
7663 return;
7664 }
7665
7666 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7667 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int)
7668 << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType();
7669
7670 // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str".
7671 if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) {
7672 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7673 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence)
7674 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&")
7675 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[")
7676 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]");
7677 } else
7678 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence);
7679 }
7680
7681 /// \brief Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string.
diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema & Self,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)7682 static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7683 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7684 const Expr *StringRefExpr = LHSExpr;
7685 const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr =
7686 dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7687
7688 if (!CharExpr) {
7689 CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts());
7690 StringRefExpr = RHSExpr;
7691 }
7692
7693 if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr)
7694 return;
7695
7696 const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType();
7697
7698 // Return if not a PointerType.
7699 if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType())
7700 return;
7701
7702 // Return if not a CharacterType.
7703 if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType())
7704 return;
7705
7706 ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext();
7707 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7708
7709 const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType();
7710 if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() &&
7711 CharType->isIntegerType() &&
7712 llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) {
7713 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char)
7714 << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy;
7715 } else {
7716 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char)
7717 << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType();
7718 }
7719
7720 // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str.
7721 if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) {
7722 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
7723 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence)
7724 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), "&")
7725 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[")
7726 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]");
7727 } else {
7728 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence);
7729 }
7730 }
7731
7732 /// \brief Emit error when two pointers are incompatible.
diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)7733 static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
7734 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
7735 assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7736 assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7737 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
7738 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange()
7739 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
7740 }
7741
CheckAdditionOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,unsigned Opc,QualType * CompLHSTy)7742 QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
7743 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
7744 QualType* CompLHSTy) {
7745 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7746
7747 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7748 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7749 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(
7750 LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy,
7751 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec,
7752 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector);
7753 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7754 return compType;
7755 }
7756
7757 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy);
7758 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7759 return QualType();
7760
7761 // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal".
7762 if (Opc == BO_Add) {
7763 diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7764 diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7765 }
7766
7767 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
7768 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) {
7769 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7770 return compType;
7771 }
7772
7773 // Type-checking. Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp;
7774 // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer.
7775 Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get();
7776
7777 bool isObjCPointer;
7778 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) {
7779 isObjCPointer = false;
7780 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7781 isObjCPointer = true;
7782 } else {
7783 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
7784 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) {
7785 isObjCPointer = false;
7786 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7787 isObjCPointer = true;
7788 } else {
7789 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7790 }
7791 }
7792 assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType());
7793
7794 if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType())
7795 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7796
7797 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp))
7798 return QualType();
7799
7800 if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp))
7801 return QualType();
7802
7803 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
7804 CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp);
7805
7806 if (CompLHSTy) {
7807 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get());
7808 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
7809 LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
7810 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
7811 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
7812 }
7813 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
7814 }
7815
7816 return PExp->getType();
7817 }
7818
7819 // C99 6.5.6
CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,QualType * CompLHSTy)7820 QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7821 SourceLocation Loc,
7822 QualType* CompLHSTy) {
7823 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
7824
7825 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
7826 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
7827 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(
7828 LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy,
7829 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec,
7830 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector);
7831 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7832 return compType;
7833 }
7834
7835 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy);
7836 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
7837 return QualType();
7838
7839 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
7840
7841 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
7842 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) {
7843 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
7844 return compType;
7845 }
7846
7847 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
7848 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
7849 QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType();
7850
7851 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
7852 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
7853 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
7854 return QualType();
7855
7856 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
7857 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
7858 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get()))
7859 return QualType();
7860
7861 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic
7862 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr,
7863 /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true);
7864
7865 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
7866 return LHS.get()->getType();
7867 }
7868
7869 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
7870 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy
7871 = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7872 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
7873
7874 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7875 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
7876 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
7877 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7878 }
7879 } else {
7880 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
7881 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
7882 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
7883 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
7884 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
7885 return QualType();
7886 }
7887 }
7888
7889 if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc,
7890 LHS.get(), RHS.get()))
7891 return QualType();
7892
7893 // The pointee type may have zero size. As an extension, a structure or
7894 // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length. In this
7895 // case subtraction does not make sense.
7896 if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
7897 CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee);
7898 if (ElementSize.isZero()) {
7899 Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types)
7900 << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType()
7901 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7902 }
7903 }
7904
7905 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType();
7906 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
7907 }
7908 }
7909
7910 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
7911 }
7912
isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T)7913 static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
7914 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
7915 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
7916 return false;
7917 }
7918
DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,unsigned Opc,QualType LHSType)7919 static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
7920 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
7921 QualType LHSType) {
7922 // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined),
7923 // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema.
7924 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL)
7925 return;
7926
7927 llvm::APSInt Right;
7928 // Check right/shifter operand
7929 if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
7930 !RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Right, S.Context))
7931 return;
7932
7933 if (Right.isNegative()) {
7934 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7935 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative)
7936 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7937 return;
7938 }
7939 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
7940 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType()));
7941 if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) {
7942 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(),
7943 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth)
7944 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7945 return;
7946 }
7947 if (Opc != BO_Shl)
7948 return;
7949
7950 // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which
7951 // according to C++ has undefined behavior ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned
7952 // integers have defined behavior modulo one more than the maximum value
7953 // representable in the result type, so never warn for those.
7954 llvm::APSInt Left;
7955 if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() ||
7956 LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation() ||
7957 !LHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Left, S.Context))
7958 return;
7959
7960 // If LHS does not have a signed type and non-negative value
7961 // then, the behavior is undefined. Warn about it.
7962 if (Left.isNegative()) {
7963 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, LHS.get(),
7964 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_lhs_negative)
7965 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange());
7966 return;
7967 }
7968
7969 llvm::APInt ResultBits =
7970 static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits();
7971 if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits))
7972 return;
7973 llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue());
7974 Result = Result.shl(Right);
7975
7976 // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned
7977 // hexadecimal number.
7978 SmallString<40> HexResult;
7979 Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true);
7980
7981 // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual
7982 // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the
7983 // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be
7984 // turned off separately if needed.
7985 if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) {
7986 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit)
7987 << HexResult << LHSType
7988 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7989 return;
7990 }
7991
7992 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth)
7993 << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType
7994 << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
7995 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
7996 }
7997
7998 /// \brief Return the resulting type when an OpenCL vector is shifted
7999 /// by a scalar or vector shift amount.
checkOpenCLVectorShift(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign)8000 static QualType checkOpenCLVectorShift(Sema &S,
8001 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8002 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
8003 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says RHS can be a vector only if LHS is a vector.
8004 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
8005 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_shift_rhs_only_vector)
8006 << RHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getType()
8007 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8008 return QualType();
8009 }
8010
8011 if (!IsCompAssign) {
8012 LHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
8013 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return QualType();
8014 }
8015
8016 RHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
8017 if (RHS.isInvalid()) return QualType();
8018
8019 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8020 const VectorType *LHSVecTy = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
8021 QualType LHSEleType = LHSVecTy->getElementType();
8022
8023 // Note that RHS might not be a vector.
8024 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8025 const VectorType *RHSVecTy = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>();
8026 QualType RHSEleType = RHSVecTy ? RHSVecTy->getElementType() : RHSType;
8027
8028 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that the operands need to be integers.
8029 if (!LHSEleType->isIntegerType()) {
8030 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int)
8031 << LHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8032 return QualType();
8033 }
8034
8035 if (!RHSEleType->isIntegerType()) {
8036 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int)
8037 << RHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8038 return QualType();
8039 }
8040
8041 if (RHSVecTy) {
8042 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that for vector types, the operators
8043 // are applied component-wise. So if RHS is a vector, then ensure
8044 // that the number of elements is the same as LHS...
8045 if (RHSVecTy->getNumElements() != LHSVecTy->getNumElements()) {
8046 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_lengths_not_equal)
8047 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
8048 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8049 return QualType();
8050 }
8051 } else {
8052 // ...else expand RHS to match the number of elements in LHS.
8053 QualType VecTy =
8054 S.Context.getExtVectorType(RHSEleType, LHSVecTy->getNumElements());
8055 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat);
8056 }
8057
8058 return LHSType;
8059 }
8060
8061 // C99 6.5.7
CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,unsigned Opc,bool IsCompAssign)8062 QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8063 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc,
8064 bool IsCompAssign) {
8065 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
8066
8067 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
8068 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
8069 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
8070 if (LangOpts.OpenCL)
8071 return checkOpenCLVectorShift(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
8072 if (LangOpts.ZVector) {
8073 // The shift operators for the z vector extensions work basically
8074 // like OpenCL shifts, except that neither the LHS nor the RHS is
8075 // allowed to be a "vector bool".
8076 if (auto LHSVecType = LHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
8077 if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool)
8078 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8079 if (auto RHSVecType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
8080 if (RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool)
8081 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8082 return checkOpenCLVectorShift(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign);
8083 }
8084 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
8085 /*AllowBothBool*/true,
8086 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
8087 }
8088
8089 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
8090 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
8091
8092 // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away
8093 // if this is a compound assignment.
8094 ExprResult OldLHS = LHS;
8095 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
8096 if (LHS.isInvalid())
8097 return QualType();
8098 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8099 if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS;
8100
8101 // The RHS is simpler.
8102 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
8103 if (RHS.isInvalid())
8104 return QualType();
8105 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8106
8107 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
8108 if (!LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
8109 !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
8110 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8111
8112 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
8113 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
8114 if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) ||
8115 isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) {
8116 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8117 }
8118 // Sanity-check shift operands
8119 DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType);
8120
8121 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
8122 return LHSType;
8123 }
8124
IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl * D)8125 static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
8126 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
8127 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
8128 return true;
8129 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
8130 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
8131 }
8132 return false;
8133 }
8134
8135 /// If two different enums are compared, raise a warning.
checkEnumComparison(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * LHS,Expr * RHS)8136 static void checkEnumComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS,
8137 Expr *RHS) {
8138 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType();
8139 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType();
8140
8141 const EnumType *LHSEnumType = LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>();
8142 if (!LHSEnumType)
8143 return;
8144 const EnumType *RHSEnumType = RHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>();
8145 if (!RHSEnumType)
8146 return;
8147
8148 // Ignore anonymous enums.
8149 if (!LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
8150 return;
8151 if (!RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
8152 return;
8153
8154 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType))
8155 return;
8156
8157 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_of_mixed_enum_types)
8158 << LHSStrippedType << RHSStrippedType
8159 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
8160 }
8161
8162 /// \brief Diagnose bad pointer comparisons.
diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,bool IsError)8163 static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8164 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8165 bool IsError) {
8166 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers
8167 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
8168 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
8169 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8170 }
8171
8172 /// \brief Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type,
8173 /// true otherwise.
convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS)8174 static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8175 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) {
8176 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
8177 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
8178 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
8179 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
8180 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
8181 //
8182 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
8183 // comparisons of pointers.
8184
8185 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
8186 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
8187 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
8188 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
8189 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
8190 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
8191 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
8192 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
8193 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
8194 // types.
8195
8196 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8197 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8198 assert((LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) ||
8199 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()));
8200
8201 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
8202 bool *BoolPtr = S.isSFINAEContext() ? nullptr : &NonStandardCompositeType;
8203 QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS, BoolPtr);
8204 if (T.isNull()) {
8205 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true);
8206 return true;
8207 }
8208
8209 if (NonStandardCompositeType)
8210 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
8211 << LHSType << RHSType << T << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8212 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8213
8214 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast);
8215 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast);
8216 return false;
8217 }
8218
diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,bool IsError)8219 static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8220 ExprResult &LHS,
8221 ExprResult &RHS,
8222 bool IsError) {
8223 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
8224 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
8225 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType()
8226 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8227 }
8228
isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult & E)8229 static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) {
8230 switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) {
8231 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass:
8232 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass:
8233 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass:
8234 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass:
8235 return true;
8236 default:
8237 // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal!
8238 return false;
8239 }
8240 }
8241
hasIsEqualMethod(Sema & S,const Expr * LHS,const Expr * RHS)8242 static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) {
8243 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type =
8244 LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8245
8246 // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out.
8247 if (!Type)
8248 return false;
8249
8250 // Get the LHS object's interface type.
8251 QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType();
8252
8253 // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out.
8254 if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType())
8255 return false;
8256
8257 // Try to find the -isEqual: method.
8258 Selector IsEqualSel = S.NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector();
8259 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = S.LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel,
8260 InterfaceType,
8261 /*instance=*/true);
8262 if (!Method) {
8263 if (Type->isObjCIdType()) {
8264 // For 'id', just check the global pool.
8265 Method = S.LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(),
8266 /*receiverId=*/true);
8267 } else {
8268 // Check protocols.
8269 Method = S.LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type,
8270 /*instance=*/true);
8271 }
8272 }
8273
8274 if (!Method)
8275 return false;
8276
8277 QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType();
8278 if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType())
8279 return false;
8280
8281 QualType R = Method->getReturnType();
8282 if (!R->isScalarType())
8283 return false;
8284
8285 return true;
8286 }
8287
CheckLiteralKind(Expr * FromE)8288 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind Sema::CheckLiteralKind(Expr *FromE) {
8289 FromE = FromE->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8290 switch (FromE->getStmtClass()) {
8291 default:
8292 break;
8293 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass:
8294 // "string literal"
8295 return LK_String;
8296 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass:
8297 // "array literal"
8298 return LK_Array;
8299 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass:
8300 // "dictionary literal"
8301 return LK_Dictionary;
8302 case Stmt::BlockExprClass:
8303 return LK_Block;
8304 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: {
8305 Expr *Inner = cast<ObjCBoxedExpr>(FromE)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
8306 switch (Inner->getStmtClass()) {
8307 case Stmt::IntegerLiteralClass:
8308 case Stmt::FloatingLiteralClass:
8309 case Stmt::CharacterLiteralClass:
8310 case Stmt::ObjCBoolLiteralExprClass:
8311 case Stmt::CXXBoolLiteralExprClass:
8312 // "numeric literal"
8313 return LK_Numeric;
8314 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: {
8315 CastKind CK = cast<CastExpr>(Inner)->getCastKind();
8316 // Boolean literals can be represented by implicit casts.
8317 if (CK == CK_IntegralToBoolean || CK == CK_IntegralCast)
8318 return LK_Numeric;
8319 break;
8320 }
8321 default:
8322 break;
8323 }
8324 return LK_Boxed;
8325 }
8326 }
8327 return LK_None;
8328 }
8329
diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc)8330 static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8331 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8332 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){
8333 Expr *Literal;
8334 Expr *Other;
8335 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) {
8336 Literal = LHS.get();
8337 Other = RHS.get();
8338 } else {
8339 Literal = RHS.get();
8340 Other = LHS.get();
8341 }
8342
8343 // Don't warn on comparisons against nil.
8344 Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts();
8345 if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(),
8346 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
8347 return;
8348
8349 // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison.
8350 // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own
8351 // warning flag.
8352 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.CheckLiteralKind(Literal);
8353 assert(LiteralKind != Sema::LK_Block);
8354 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_None) {
8355 llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind");
8356 }
8357
8358 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_String)
8359 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison)
8360 << Literal->getSourceRange();
8361 else
8362 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison)
8363 << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange();
8364
8365 if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) &&
8366 hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) {
8367 SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getLocStart();
8368 SourceLocation End = S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd());
8369 CharSourceRange OpRange =
8370 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc));
8371
8372 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal)
8373 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![")
8374 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:")
8375 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]");
8376 }
8377 }
8378
diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,unsigned OpaqueOpc)8379 static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS,
8380 ExprResult &RHS,
8381 SourceLocation Loc,
8382 unsigned OpaqueOpc) {
8383 // This checking requires bools.
8384 if (!S.getLangOpts().Bool) return;
8385
8386 // Check that left hand side is !something.
8387 UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts());
8388 if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return;
8389
8390 // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type.
8391 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType()) return;
8392
8393 // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool.
8394 Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts();
8395 if (SubExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) return;
8396
8397 // Emit warning.
8398 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_comparison)
8399 << Loc;
8400
8401 // First note suggest !(x < y)
8402 SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getLocStart();
8403 SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getLocEnd();
8404 FirstClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose);
8405 if (FirstClose.isInvalid())
8406 FirstOpen = SourceLocation();
8407 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix)
8408 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(")
8409 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")");
8410
8411 // Second note suggests (!x) < y
8412 SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getLocStart();
8413 SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getLocEnd();
8414 SecondClose = S.getPreprocessor().getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose);
8415 if (SecondClose.isInvalid())
8416 SecondOpen = SourceLocation();
8417 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens)
8418 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(")
8419 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")");
8420 }
8421
8422 // Get the decl for a simple expression: a reference to a variable,
8423 // an implicit C++ field reference, or an implicit ObjC ivar reference.
getCompareDecl(Expr * E)8424 static ValueDecl *getCompareDecl(Expr *E) {
8425 if (DeclRefExpr* DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
8426 return DR->getDecl();
8427 if (ObjCIvarRefExpr* Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) {
8428 if (Ivar->isFreeIvar())
8429 return Ivar->getDecl();
8430 }
8431 if (MemberExpr* Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
8432 if (Mem->isImplicitAccess())
8433 return Mem->getMemberDecl();
8434 }
8435 return nullptr;
8436 }
8437
8438 // C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,unsigned OpaqueOpc,bool IsRelational)8439 QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8440 SourceLocation Loc, unsigned OpaqueOpc,
8441 bool IsRelational) {
8442 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/true);
8443
8444 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
8445
8446 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
8447 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
8448 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
8449 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsRelational);
8450
8451 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8452 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8453
8454 Expr *LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8455 Expr *RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8456
8457 checkEnumComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
8458 diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofComparison(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, OpaqueOpc);
8459
8460 if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
8461 !(LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && IsRelational) &&
8462 !LHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
8463 !RHS.get()->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
8464 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) {
8465 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
8466 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
8467 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
8468 //
8469 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
8470 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
8471 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
8472 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
8473 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
8474 // result.
8475 ValueDecl *DL = getCompareDecl(LHSStripped);
8476 ValueDecl *DR = getCompareDecl(RHSStripped);
8477 if (DL && DR && DL == DR && !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DL)) {
8478 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
8479 << 0 // self-
8480 << (Opc == BO_EQ
8481 || Opc == BO_LE
8482 || Opc == BO_GE));
8483 } else if (DL && DR && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType() &&
8484 !DL->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
8485 !DR->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
8486 // what is it always going to eval to?
8487 char always_evals_to;
8488 switch(Opc) {
8489 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
8490 always_evals_to = 0; // false
8491 break;
8492 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
8493 always_evals_to = 1; // true
8494 break;
8495 default:
8496 // best we can say is 'a constant'
8497 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
8498 break;
8499 }
8500 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
8501 << 1 // array
8502 << always_evals_to);
8503 }
8504
8505 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
8506 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
8507 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
8508 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
8509
8510 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
8511 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
8512 Expr *literalString = nullptr;
8513 Expr *literalStringStripped = nullptr;
8514 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
8515 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
8516 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
8517 literalString = LHS.get();
8518 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
8519 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
8520 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
8521 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
8522 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
8523 literalString = RHS.get();
8524 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
8525 }
8526
8527 if (literalString) {
8528 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
8529 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
8530 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
8531 << literalString->getSourceRange());
8532 }
8533 }
8534
8535 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
8536 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
8537 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
8538 return QualType();
8539
8540 LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8541 RHSType = RHS.get()->getType();
8542
8543 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
8544 QualType ResultTy = Context.getLogicalOperationType();
8545
8546 if (IsRelational) {
8547 if (LHSType->isRealType() && RHSType->isRealType())
8548 return ResultTy;
8549 } else {
8550 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
8551 if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
8552 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
8553
8554 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType())
8555 return ResultTy;
8556 }
8557
8558 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind =
8559 LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
8560 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind =
8561 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
8562 bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull;
8563 bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull;
8564
8565 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) {
8566 bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ;
8567 if (RHSIsNull)
8568 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality,
8569 RHS.get()->getSourceRange());
8570 else
8571 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality,
8572 LHS.get()->getSourceRange());
8573 }
8574
8575 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
8576 // when handling null pointer constants.
8577 if (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
8578 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
8579 LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
8580 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
8581 RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType();
8582
8583 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8584 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
8585 return ResultTy;
8586 if (!IsRelational &&
8587 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
8588 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
8589 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
8590 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
8591 // conformance with the C++ standard.
8592 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
8593 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
8594 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(
8595 *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext());
8596
8597 if (isSFINAEContext())
8598 return QualType();
8599
8600 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
8601 return ResultTy;
8602 }
8603 }
8604
8605 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
8606 return QualType();
8607 else
8608 return ResultTy;
8609 }
8610 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
8611 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
8612 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
8613 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
8614 if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
8615 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
8616 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8617 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8618 }
8619 } else if (!IsRelational &&
8620 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
8621 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
8622 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
8623 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8624 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
8625 /*isError*/false);
8626 } else {
8627 // Invalid
8628 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false);
8629 }
8630 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) {
8631 const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
8632 if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())) {
8633 Diag(Loc,
8634 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers)
8635 << LHSType << RHSType << 0 /* comparison */
8636 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8637 }
8638 unsigned AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace();
8639 unsigned AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace();
8640 CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion
8641 : CK_BitCast;
8642 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8643 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind);
8644 else
8645 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind);
8646 }
8647 return ResultTy;
8648 }
8649
8650 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8651 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
8652 if (LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isNullPtrType())
8653 return ResultTy;
8654
8655 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
8656 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
8657 if (RHSIsNull &&
8658 ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() || LHSType->isNullPtrType()) ||
8659 (!IsRelational &&
8660 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) {
8661 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
8662 LHSType->isMemberPointerType()
8663 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
8664 : CK_NullToPointer);
8665 return ResultTy;
8666 }
8667 if (LHSIsNull &&
8668 ((RHSType->isAnyPointerType() || RHSType->isNullPtrType()) ||
8669 (!IsRelational &&
8670 (RHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())))) {
8671 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
8672 RHSType->isMemberPointerType()
8673 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
8674 : CK_NullToPointer);
8675 return ResultTy;
8676 }
8677
8678 // Comparison of member pointers.
8679 if (!IsRelational &&
8680 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() && RHSType->isMemberPointerType()) {
8681 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS))
8682 return QualType();
8683 else
8684 return ResultTy;
8685 }
8686
8687 // Handle scoped enumeration types specifically, since they don't promote
8688 // to integers.
8689 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isEnumeralType() &&
8690 Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS.get()->getType(),
8691 RHS.get()->getType()))
8692 return ResultTy;
8693 }
8694
8695 // Handle block pointer types.
8696 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() &&
8697 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
8698 QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8699 QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
8700
8701 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
8702 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
8703 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
8704 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8705 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8706 }
8707 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
8708 return ResultTy;
8709 }
8710
8711 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
8712 if (!IsRelational
8713 && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType())
8714 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
8715 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
8716 if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
8717 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
8718 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()
8719 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
8720 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
8721 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8722 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8723 }
8724 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8725 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
8726 RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
8727 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
8728 else
8729 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
8730 LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast
8731 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast);
8732 return ResultTy;
8733 }
8734
8735 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
8736 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8737 const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
8738 const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>();
8739 if (LPT || RPT) {
8740 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
8741 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false;
8742
8743 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
8744 !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) {
8745 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
8746 /*isError*/false);
8747 }
8748 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
8749 Expr *E = LHS.get();
8750 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
8751 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion);
8752 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType,
8753 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
8754 }
8755 else {
8756 Expr *E = RHS.get();
8757 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
8758 CheckObjCARCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, false,
8759 Opc);
8760 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType,
8761 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast);
8762 }
8763 return ResultTy;
8764 }
8765 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
8766 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
8767 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType))
8768 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS,
8769 /*isError*/false);
8770 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS))
8771 diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc);
8772
8773 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull)
8774 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast);
8775 else
8776 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast);
8777 return ResultTy;
8778 }
8779 }
8780 if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
8781 (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) {
8782 unsigned DiagID = 0;
8783 bool isError = false;
8784 if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) {
8785 // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers,
8786 // since users tend to want to compare addresses.
8787 } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) ||
8788 (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) {
8789 if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
8790 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
8791 } else if (IsRelational && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
8792 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
8793 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8794 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
8795 isError = true;
8796 } else
8797 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
8798
8799 if (DiagID) {
8800 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
8801 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8802 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange();
8803 if (isError)
8804 return QualType();
8805 }
8806
8807 if (LHSType->isIntegerType())
8808 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType,
8809 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
8810 else
8811 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType,
8812 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
8813 return ResultTy;
8814 }
8815
8816 // Handle block pointers.
8817 if (!IsRelational && RHSIsNull
8818 && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) {
8819 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
8820 return ResultTy;
8821 }
8822 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull
8823 && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) {
8824 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer);
8825 return ResultTy;
8826 }
8827
8828 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8829 }
8830
8831
8832 // Return a signed type that is of identical size and number of elements.
8833 // For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical size
8834 // and number of elements.
GetSignedVectorType(QualType V)8835 QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) {
8836 const VectorType *VTy = V->getAs<VectorType>();
8837 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
8838 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy))
8839 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8840 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy))
8841 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8842 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
8843 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8844 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
8845 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8846 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
8847 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
8848 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
8849 }
8850
8851 /// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
8852 /// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
8853 /// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
8854 /// types.
CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsRelational)8855 QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8856 SourceLocation Loc,
8857 bool IsRelational) {
8858 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
8859 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
8860 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false,
8861 /*AllowBothBool*/true,
8862 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector);
8863 if (vType.isNull())
8864 return vType;
8865
8866 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType();
8867
8868 // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e.
8869 // bool for C++, int for C
8870 if (getLangOpts().AltiVec &&
8871 vType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector)
8872 return Context.getLogicalOperationType();
8873
8874 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
8875 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
8876 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
8877 if (!LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
8878 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) {
8879 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL
8880 = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()))
8881 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR
8882 = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()))
8883 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
8884 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr,
8885 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
8886 << 0 // self-
8887 << 2 // "a constant"
8888 );
8889 }
8890
8891 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
8892 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
8893 assert (RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation());
8894 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get());
8895 }
8896
8897 // Return a signed type for the vector.
8898 return GetSignedVectorType(LHSType);
8899 }
8900
CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc)8901 QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
8902 SourceLocation Loc) {
8903 // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or
8904 // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type.
8905 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false,
8906 /*AllowBothBool*/true,
8907 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false);
8908 if (vType.isNull())
8909 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8910 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 &&
8911 vType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
8912 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8913
8914 return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType());
8915 }
8916
CheckBitwiseOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,bool IsCompAssign)8917 inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
8918 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) {
8919 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompare=*/false);
8920
8921 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() ||
8922 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) {
8923 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
8924 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
8925 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign,
8926 /*AllowBothBool*/true,
8927 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector);
8928 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8929 }
8930
8931 ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS;
8932 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHSResult, RHSResult,
8933 IsCompAssign);
8934 if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid())
8935 return QualType();
8936 LHS = LHSResult.get();
8937 RHS = RHSResult.get();
8938
8939 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
8940 return compType;
8941 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8942 }
8943
CheckLogicalOperands(ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,unsigned Opc)8944 inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
8945 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
8946
8947 // Check vector operands differently.
8948 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType())
8949 return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc);
8950
8951 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
8952 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
8953 // is a constant.
8954 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() &&
8955 !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
8956 RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() &&
8957 // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations.
8958 !Loc.isMacroID() && ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty()) {
8959 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
8960 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
8961 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
8962 // Parens on the RHS are ignored.
8963 llvm::APSInt Result;
8964 if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context))
8965 if ((getLangOpts().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
8966 !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) ||
8967 (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) {
8968 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
8969 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()
8970 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||");
8971 // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version
8972 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator)
8973 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|")
8974 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(
8975 Loc, Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(Loc, 0, getSourceManager(),
8976 getLangOpts())),
8977 Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
8978 if (Opc == BO_LAnd)
8979 // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()"
8980 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant)
8981 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
8982 SourceRange(
8983 Lexer::getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getLocEnd(),
8984 0, getSourceManager(),
8985 getLangOpts()),
8986 RHS.get()->getLocEnd()));
8987 }
8988 }
8989
8990 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8991 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do
8992 // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types.
8993 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
8994 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
8995 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() ||
8996 RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType())
8997 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
8998 }
8999
9000 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get());
9001 if (LHS.isInvalid())
9002 return QualType();
9003
9004 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get());
9005 if (RHS.isInvalid())
9006 return QualType();
9007
9008 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() ||
9009 !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType())
9010 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
9011
9012 return Context.IntTy;
9013 }
9014
9015 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
9016 // non-overloadable operands.
9017
9018 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
9019 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
9020 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
9021 ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get());
9022 if (LHSRes.isInvalid())
9023 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
9024 LHS = LHSRes;
9025
9026 ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get());
9027 if (RHSRes.isInvalid())
9028 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS);
9029 RHS = RHSRes;
9030
9031 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
9032 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
9033 // The result is a bool.
9034 return Context.BoolTy;
9035 }
9036
IsReadonlyMessage(Expr * E,Sema & S)9037 static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
9038 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E);
9039 if (!ME) return false;
9040 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false;
9041 ObjCMessageExpr *Base =
9042 dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
9043 if (!Base) return false;
9044 return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr;
9045 }
9046
9047 /// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a
9048 /// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become
9049 /// 'const' due to being captured within a block?
9050 enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda };
isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema & S,Expr * E)9051 static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
9052 assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified());
9053 E = E->IgnoreParens();
9054
9055 // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope.
9056 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
9057 if (!DRE) return NCCK_None;
9058 if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) return NCCK_None;
9059
9060 // The declaration must be a variable which is not declared 'const'.
9061 VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
9062 if (!var) return NCCK_None;
9063 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) return NCCK_None;
9064 assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?");
9065
9066 // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda.
9067 DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr;
9068 while (DC != var->getDeclContext()) {
9069 Prev = DC;
9070 DC = DC->getParent();
9071 }
9072 // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far.
9073 if (!var->isInitCapture())
9074 DC = Prev;
9075 return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda);
9076 }
9077
IsTypeModifiable(QualType Ty,bool IsDereference)9078 static bool IsTypeModifiable(QualType Ty, bool IsDereference) {
9079 Ty = Ty.getNonReferenceType();
9080 if (IsDereference && Ty->isPointerType())
9081 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType();
9082 return !Ty.isConstQualified();
9083 }
9084
9085 /// Emit the "read-only variable not assignable" error and print notes to give
9086 /// more information about why the variable is not assignable, such as pointing
9087 /// to the declaration of a const variable, showing that a method is const, or
9088 /// that the function is returning a const reference.
DiagnoseConstAssignment(Sema & S,const Expr * E,SourceLocation Loc)9089 static void DiagnoseConstAssignment(Sema &S, const Expr *E,
9090 SourceLocation Loc) {
9091 // Update err_typecheck_assign_const and note_typecheck_assign_const
9092 // when this enum is changed.
9093 enum {
9094 ConstFunction,
9095 ConstVariable,
9096 ConstMember,
9097 ConstMethod,
9098 ConstUnknown, // Keep as last element
9099 };
9100
9101 SourceRange ExprRange = E->getSourceRange();
9102
9103 // Only emit one error on the first const found. All other consts will emit
9104 // a note to the error.
9105 bool DiagnosticEmitted = false;
9106
9107 // Track if the current expression is the result of a derefence, and if the
9108 // next checked expression is the result of a derefence.
9109 bool IsDereference = false;
9110 bool NextIsDereference = false;
9111
9112 // Loop to process MemberExpr chains.
9113 while (true) {
9114 IsDereference = NextIsDereference;
9115 NextIsDereference = false;
9116
9117 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
9118 if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
9119 NextIsDereference = ME->isArrow();
9120 const ValueDecl *VD = ME->getMemberDecl();
9121 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
9122 // Mutable fields can be modified even if the class is const.
9123 if (Field->isMutable()) {
9124 assert(DiagnosticEmitted && "Expected diagnostic not emitted.");
9125 break;
9126 }
9127
9128 if (!IsTypeModifiable(Field->getType(), IsDereference)) {
9129 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
9130 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
9131 << ExprRange << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field
9132 << Field->getType();
9133 DiagnosticEmitted = true;
9134 }
9135 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
9136 << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field << Field->getType()
9137 << Field->getSourceRange();
9138 }
9139 E = ME->getBase();
9140 continue;
9141 } else if (const VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD)) {
9142 if (VDecl->getType().isConstQualified()) {
9143 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
9144 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
9145 << ExprRange << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl
9146 << VDecl->getType();
9147 DiagnosticEmitted = true;
9148 }
9149 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
9150 << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl << VDecl->getType()
9151 << VDecl->getSourceRange();
9152 }
9153 // Static fields do not inherit constness from parents.
9154 break;
9155 }
9156 break;
9157 } // End MemberExpr
9158 break;
9159 }
9160
9161 if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
9162 // Function calls
9163 const FunctionDecl *FD = CE->getDirectCallee();
9164 if (!IsTypeModifiable(FD->getReturnType(), IsDereference)) {
9165 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
9166 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange
9167 << ConstFunction << FD;
9168 DiagnosticEmitted = true;
9169 }
9170 S.Diag(FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(),
9171 diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
9172 << ConstFunction << FD << FD->getReturnType()
9173 << FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
9174 }
9175 } else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
9176 // Point to variable declaration.
9177 if (const ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl()) {
9178 if (!IsTypeModifiable(VD->getType(), IsDereference)) {
9179 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
9180 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const)
9181 << ExprRange << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType();
9182 DiagnosticEmitted = true;
9183 }
9184 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
9185 << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType() << VD->getSourceRange();
9186 }
9187 }
9188 } else if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(E)) {
9189 if (const DeclContext *DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext()) {
9190 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
9191 if (MD->isConst()) {
9192 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) {
9193 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange
9194 << ConstMethod << MD;
9195 DiagnosticEmitted = true;
9196 }
9197 S.Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const)
9198 << ConstMethod << MD << MD->getSourceRange();
9199 }
9200 }
9201 }
9202 }
9203
9204 if (DiagnosticEmitted)
9205 return;
9206
9207 // Can't determine a more specific message, so display the generic error.
9208 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange << ConstUnknown;
9209 }
9210
9211 /// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
9212 /// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr * E,SourceLocation Loc,Sema & S)9213 static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
9214 assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject));
9215 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
9216 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
9217 &Loc);
9218 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S))
9219 IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression;
9220 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
9221 return false;
9222
9223 unsigned DiagID = 0;
9224 bool NeedType = false;
9225 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
9226 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified:
9227 // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object
9228 // from an enclosing function or block.
9229 if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) {
9230 if (NCCK == NCCK_Block)
9231 DiagID = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
9232 else
9233 DiagID = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
9234 break;
9235 }
9236
9237 // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we
9238 // infer 'const'. These are always pseudo-strong variables.
9239 if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
9240 DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts());
9241 if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) {
9242 VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl());
9243
9244 // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the
9245 // user actually wrote 'const'.
9246 if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() &&
9247 (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() ||
9248 !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) {
9249 // There are two pseudo-strong cases:
9250 // - self
9251 ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl();
9252 if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl())
9253 DiagID = method->isClassMethod()
9254 ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method
9255 : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self;
9256
9257 // - fast enumeration variables
9258 else
9259 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration;
9260
9261 SourceRange Assign;
9262 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
9263 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
9264 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
9265 // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool
9266 // can do its job.
9267 return false;
9268 }
9269 }
9270 }
9271
9272 // If none of the special cases above are triggered, then this is a
9273 // simple const assignment.
9274 if (DiagID == 0) {
9275 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc);
9276 return true;
9277 }
9278
9279 break;
9280 case Expr::MLV_ConstAddrSpace:
9281 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc);
9282 return true;
9283 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
9284 case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary:
9285 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
9286 NeedType = true;
9287 break;
9288 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
9289 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
9290 NeedType = true;
9291 break;
9292 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
9293 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
9294 break;
9295 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
9296 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
9297 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
9298 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
9299 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
9300 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
9301 break;
9302 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
9303 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
9304 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
9305 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E);
9306 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
9307 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
9308 break;
9309 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
9310 llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently");
9311 case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression:
9312 DiagID = diag::error_readonly_message_assignment;
9313 break;
9314 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
9315 DiagID = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
9316 break;
9317 }
9318
9319 SourceRange Assign;
9320 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
9321 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
9322 if (NeedType)
9323 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
9324 else
9325 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
9326 return true;
9327 }
9328
CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr,SourceLocation Loc,Sema & Sema)9329 static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
9330 SourceLocation Loc,
9331 Sema &Sema) {
9332 // C / C++ fields
9333 MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr);
9334 MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr);
9335 if (ML && MR && ML->getMemberDecl() == MR->getMemberDecl()) {
9336 if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase()))
9337 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0;
9338 }
9339
9340 // Objective-C instance variables
9341 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
9342 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
9343 if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) {
9344 DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts());
9345 DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts());
9346 if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl())
9347 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1;
9348 }
9349 }
9350
9351 // C99 6.5.16.1
CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr * LHSExpr,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc,QualType CompoundType)9352 QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS,
9353 SourceLocation Loc,
9354 QualType CompoundType) {
9355 assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject));
9356
9357 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
9358 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this))
9359 return QualType();
9360
9361 QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType();
9362 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() :
9363 CompoundType;
9364 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
9365 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
9366 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get();
9367
9368 CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this);
9369
9370 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
9371 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
9372 if (RHS.isInvalid())
9373 return QualType();
9374 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
9375 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
9376 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
9377 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
9378 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
9379 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
9380 ConvTy = Compatible;
9381
9382 if (ConvTy == Compatible &&
9383 LHSType->isObjCObjectType())
9384 Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment)
9385 << LHSType;
9386
9387 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
9388 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
9389 // instead of "x += 4".
9390 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
9391 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
9392 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
9393 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
9394 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
9395 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
9396 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
9397 Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
9398 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
9399 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
9400 Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
9401 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
9402 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
9403 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
9404 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
9405 }
9406 }
9407
9408 if (ConvTy == Compatible) {
9409 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) {
9410 // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but
9411 // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is
9412 // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference!
9413 const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts();
9414 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS);
9415 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
9416 checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get());
9417
9418 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable.
9419 // Although this code can still have problems:
9420 // id x = self.weakProp;
9421 // id y = self.weakProp;
9422 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate
9423 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if
9424 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive.
9425 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak,
9426 RHS.get()->getLocStart()))
9427 getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get());
9428
9429 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
9430 checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get());
9431 }
9432 }
9433 } else {
9434 // Compound assignment "x += y"
9435 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType);
9436 }
9437
9438 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
9439 RHS.get(), AA_Assigning))
9440 return QualType();
9441
9442 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr);
9443
9444 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
9445 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
9446 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
9447 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
9448 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
9449 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
9450 // operand.
9451 return (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
9452 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
9453 }
9454
9455 // C99 6.5.17
CheckCommaOperands(Sema & S,ExprResult & LHS,ExprResult & RHS,SourceLocation Loc)9456 static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS,
9457 SourceLocation Loc) {
9458 LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get());
9459 RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get());
9460 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
9461 return QualType();
9462
9463 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
9464 // operands, but not unary promotions.
9465 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
9466
9467 // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the
9468 // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS.
9469 LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get());
9470 if (LHS.isInvalid())
9471 return QualType();
9472
9473 S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get());
9474
9475 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9476 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get());
9477 if (RHS.isInvalid())
9478 return QualType();
9479 if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType())
9480 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(),
9481 diag::err_incomplete_type);
9482 }
9483
9484 return RHS.get()->getType();
9485 }
9486
9487 /// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
9488 /// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema & S,Expr * Op,ExprValueKind & VK,ExprObjectKind & OK,SourceLocation OpLoc,bool IsInc,bool IsPrefix)9489 static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op,
9490 ExprValueKind &VK,
9491 ExprObjectKind &OK,
9492 SourceLocation OpLoc,
9493 bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) {
9494 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
9495 return S.Context.DependentTy;
9496
9497 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
9498 // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic
9499 // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of
9500 // checking.
9501 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>())
9502 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType();
9503
9504 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
9505
9506 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
9507 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
9508 if (!IsInc) {
9509 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
9510 return QualType();
9511 }
9512 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
9513 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
9514 } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) {
9515 // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode
9516 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType;
9517 return QualType();
9518 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
9519 // OK!
9520 } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) {
9521 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
9522 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op))
9523 return QualType();
9524 } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
9525 // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden.
9526 // Otherwise, we just need a complete type.
9527 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) ||
9528 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op))
9529 return QualType();
9530 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
9531 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
9532 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
9533 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
9534 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
9535 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
9536 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
9537 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc,
9538 IsInc, IsPrefix);
9539 } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) {
9540 // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 )
9541 } else if (S.getLangOpts().ZVector && ResType->isVectorType() &&
9542 (ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() !=
9543 VectorType::AltiVecBool)) {
9544 // The z vector extensions allow ++ and -- for non-bool vectors.
9545 } else if(S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() &&
9546 ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) {
9547 // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types.
9548 } else {
9549 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
9550 << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
9551 return QualType();
9552 }
9553 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
9554 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
9555 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S))
9556 return QualType();
9557 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
9558 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
9559 // operand.
9560 if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9561 VK = VK_LValue;
9562 OK = Op->getObjectKind();
9563 return ResType;
9564 } else {
9565 VK = VK_RValue;
9566 return ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
9567 }
9568 }
9569
9570
9571 /// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
9572 /// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
9573 /// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
9574 /// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
9575 /// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
9576 /// - &(x) => x
9577 /// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
9578 /// - &s.xx => s
9579 /// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
9580 /// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
9581 /// - &"123"[2] -> 0
9582 /// - & __real__ x -> x
getPrimaryDecl(Expr * E)9583 static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
9584 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
9585 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
9586 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
9587 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
9588 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
9589 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
9590 // irrelevant.
9591 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
9592 return nullptr;
9593 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
9594 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
9595 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
9596 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
9597 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
9598 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
9599 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
9600 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
9601 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
9602 }
9603 return nullptr;
9604 }
9605 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
9606 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
9607
9608 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
9609 case UO_Real:
9610 case UO_Imag:
9611 case UO_Extension:
9612 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
9613 default:
9614 return nullptr;
9615 }
9616 }
9617 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
9618 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
9619 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
9620 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
9621 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
9622 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
9623 default:
9624 return nullptr;
9625 }
9626 }
9627
9628 namespace {
9629 enum {
9630 AO_Bit_Field = 0,
9631 AO_Vector_Element = 1,
9632 AO_Property_Expansion = 2,
9633 AO_Register_Variable = 3,
9634 AO_No_Error = 4
9635 };
9636 }
9637 /// \brief Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations.
9638 ///
9639 /// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken.
diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * E,unsigned Type)9640 static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
9641 Expr *E, unsigned Type) {
9642 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange();
9643 }
9644
9645 /// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
9646 /// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
9647 /// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
9648 /// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
9649 /// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
9650 /// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
9651 /// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult & OrigOp,SourceLocation OpLoc)9652 QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9653 if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){
9654 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
9655 Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens();
9656 if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) {
9657 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf);
9658 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function)
9659 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9660 return QualType();
9661 }
9662
9663 OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E);
9664 if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl))
9665 if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) {
9666 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9667 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9668 return QualType();
9669 }
9670
9671 return Context.OverloadTy;
9672 }
9673
9674 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny)
9675 return Context.UnknownAnyTy;
9676
9677 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) {
9678 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9679 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9680 return QualType();
9681 }
9682
9683 OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get());
9684 if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType();
9685 }
9686
9687 if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent())
9688 return Context.DependentTy;
9689
9690 assert(!OrigOp.get()->getType()->isPlaceholderType());
9691
9692 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
9693 Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens();
9694
9695 // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed.
9696 if (LangOpts.OpenCL && op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
9697 Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_function_address);
9698 return QualType();
9699 }
9700
9701 if (getLangOpts().C99) {
9702 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
9703 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
9704 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
9705 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
9706 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
9707 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
9708 }
9709 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
9710 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
9711 }
9712 ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
9713 Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context);
9714 unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error;
9715
9716 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) {
9717 bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext();
9718 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary
9719 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary)
9720 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
9721 if (sfinae)
9722 return QualType();
9723 // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address.
9724 OrigOp = op = new (Context)
9725 MaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true);
9726 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
9727 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
9728 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
9729 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
9730 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
9731
9732 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
9733 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
9734 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
9735 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9736 return QualType();
9737 }
9738 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
9739 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
9740
9741 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
9742 if (OrigOp.get() != DRE) {
9743 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
9744 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange();
9745
9746 // The method was named without a qualifier.
9747 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
9748 if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty())
9749 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
9750 << op->getSourceRange();
9751 else {
9752 SmallString<32> Str;
9753 StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str);
9754 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
9755 << op->getSourceRange()
9756 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(op->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual);
9757 }
9758 }
9759
9760 // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2.
9761 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD))
9762 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor) << op->getSourceRange();
9763
9764 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType(
9765 op->getType(), Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
9766 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9767 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0);
9768 return MPTy;
9769 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
9770 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
9771 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
9772 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
9773 // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references.
9774 if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) {
9775 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion;
9776 } else {
9777 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
9778 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
9779 return QualType();
9780 }
9781 }
9782 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
9783 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
9784 AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field;
9785 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) {
9786 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
9787 AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element;
9788 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
9789 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
9790 // with the register storage-class specifier.
9791 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
9792 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
9793 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
9794 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
9795 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9796 AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable;
9797 }
9798 } else if (isa<MSPropertyDecl>(dcl)) {
9799 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion;
9800 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
9801 return Context.OverloadTy;
9802 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) {
9803 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
9804 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
9805 // scope qualifier for the class.
9806 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
9807 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
9808 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
9809 if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
9810 Diag(OpLoc,
9811 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
9812 << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType();
9813 return QualType();
9814 }
9815
9816 while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
9817 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
9818
9819 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType(
9820 op->getType(),
9821 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
9822 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
9823 RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy, 0);
9824 return MPTy;
9825 }
9826 }
9827 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl))
9828 llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type");
9829 }
9830
9831 if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) {
9832 diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError);
9833 return QualType();
9834 }
9835
9836 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
9837 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
9838 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
9839 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
9840 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
9841 }
9842
9843 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
9844 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
9845 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
9846 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
9847 }
9848
RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema & S,const Expr * Exp)9849 static void RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema &S, const Expr *Exp) {
9850 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Exp);
9851 if (!DRE)
9852 return;
9853 const Decl *D = DRE->getDecl();
9854 if (!D)
9855 return;
9856 const ParmVarDecl *Param = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D);
9857 if (!Param)
9858 return;
9859 if (const FunctionDecl* FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Param->getDeclContext()))
9860 if (!FD->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>() && !Param->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>())
9861 return;
9862 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FD = S.getCurFunction())
9863 if (!FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.count(Param))
9864 FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.insert(Param);
9865 }
9866
9867 /// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema & S,Expr * Op,ExprValueKind & VK,SourceLocation OpLoc)9868 static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK,
9869 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9870 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
9871 return S.Context.DependentTy;
9872
9873 ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
9874 if (ConvResult.isInvalid())
9875 return QualType();
9876 Op = ConvResult.get();
9877 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
9878 QualType Result;
9879
9880 if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) {
9881 QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType();
9882 S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true,
9883 Op->getSourceRange());
9884 }
9885
9886 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
9887 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
9888 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
9889 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
9890 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
9891 else {
9892 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op);
9893 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
9894 if (PR.get() != Op)
9895 return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc);
9896 }
9897
9898 if (Result.isNull()) {
9899 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
9900 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
9901 return QualType();
9902 }
9903
9904 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if Result
9905 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
9906 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
9907 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes. In C++, indirection is not valid
9908 // for pointers to 'void' but is fine for any other pointer type:
9909 //
9910 // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1:
9911 // [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall
9912 // be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type
9913 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result->isVoidType())
9914 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer)
9915 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
9916
9917 // Dereferences are usually l-values...
9918 VK = VK_LValue;
9919
9920 // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C.
9921 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType())
9922 VK = VK_RValue;
9923
9924 return Result;
9925 }
9926
ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind)9927 BinaryOperatorKind Sema::ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind) {
9928 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
9929 switch (Kind) {
9930 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
9931 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
9932 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
9933 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
9934 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
9935 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
9936 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
9937 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
9938 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
9939 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
9940 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
9941 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
9942 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
9943 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
9944 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
9945 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
9946 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
9947 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
9948 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
9949 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
9950 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
9951 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
9952 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
9953 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
9954 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
9955 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
9956 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
9957 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
9958 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
9959 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
9960 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
9961 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
9962 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
9963 }
9964 return Opc;
9965 }
9966
ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind)9967 static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
9968 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
9969 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
9970 switch (Kind) {
9971 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!");
9972 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
9973 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
9974 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
9975 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
9976 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
9977 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
9978 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
9979 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
9980 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
9981 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
9982 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
9983 }
9984 return Opc;
9985 }
9986
9987 /// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself.
9988 /// This warning is only emitted for builtin assignment operations. It is also
9989 /// suppressed in the event of macro expansions.
DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema & S,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr,SourceLocation OpLoc)9990 static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
9991 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9992 if (!S.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty())
9993 return;
9994 if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID())
9995 return;
9996 LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
9997 RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
9998 const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr);
9999 const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr);
10000 if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef ||
10001 LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() ||
10002 RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID())
10003 return;
10004 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl =
10005 cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
10006 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl =
10007 cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
10008 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl)
10009 return;
10010 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified())
10011 return;
10012 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>())
10013 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified())
10014 return;
10015
10016 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_self_assignment)
10017 << LHSDeclRef->getType()
10018 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange();
10019 }
10020
10021 /// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer. This
10022 /// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer.
checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema & S,ExprResult & L,ExprResult & R,SourceLocation OpLoc)10023 static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R,
10024 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
10025 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1)
10026 return;
10027
10028 const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr;
10029 const Expr *LHS = L.get();
10030 const Expr *RHS = R.get();
10031
10032 if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
10033 ObjCPointerExpr = LHS;
10034 OtherExpr = RHS;
10035 }
10036 else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
10037 ObjCPointerExpr = RHS;
10038 OtherExpr = LHS;
10039 }
10040
10041 // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false
10042 // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing. This logic mainly
10043 // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which
10044 // code should generally never do.
10045 if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
10046 unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking;
10047 // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX.
10048 const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts();
10049 // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which
10050 // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value.
10051 // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase.
10052 if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) {
10053 Selector S = ME->getSelector();
10054 StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0);
10055 if (SelArg0.startswith("performSelector"))
10056 Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector;
10057 }
10058
10059 S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag)
10060 << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange();
10061 }
10062 }
10063
getDeclFromExpr(Expr * E)10064 static NamedDecl *getDeclFromExpr(Expr *E) {
10065 if (!E)
10066 return nullptr;
10067 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E))
10068 return DRE->getDecl();
10069 if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
10070 return ME->getMemberDecl();
10071 if (auto *IRE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E))
10072 return IRE->getDecl();
10073 return nullptr;
10074 }
10075
10076 /// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
10077 /// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
10078 /// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)10079 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
10080 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10081 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10082 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) {
10083 // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment,
10084 // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for
10085 // non-assignment operators.
10086 // C++11 5.17p9:
10087 // The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning
10088 // of x = {} is x = T().
10089 InitializationKind Kind =
10090 InitializationKind::CreateDirectList(RHSExpr->getLocStart());
10091 InitializedEntity Entity =
10092 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType());
10093 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr);
10094 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr);
10095 if (Init.isInvalid())
10096 return Init;
10097 RHSExpr = Init.get();
10098 }
10099
10100 ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr;
10101 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
10102 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
10103 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
10104 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
10105 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
10106 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
10107
10108 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10109 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it
10110 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
10111 // been dealt with before checking the operands.
10112 LHS = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHSExpr);
10113 RHS = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHSExpr, [Opc, LHS](Expr *E) {
10114 if (Opc != BO_Assign)
10115 return ExprResult(E);
10116 // Avoid correcting the RHS to the same Expr as the LHS.
10117 Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E);
10118 return (D && D == getDeclFromExpr(LHS.get())) ? ExprError() : E;
10119 });
10120 if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable())
10121 return ExprError();
10122 }
10123
10124 switch (Opc) {
10125 case BO_Assign:
10126 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType());
10127 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
10128 LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) {
10129 VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind();
10130 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
10131 }
10132 if (!ResultTy.isNull()) {
10133 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
10134 DiagnoseSelfMove(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
10135 }
10136 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, LHS.get());
10137 break;
10138 case BO_PtrMemD:
10139 case BO_PtrMemI:
10140 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc,
10141 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
10142 break;
10143 case BO_Mul:
10144 case BO_Div:
10145 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false,
10146 Opc == BO_Div);
10147 break;
10148 case BO_Rem:
10149 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
10150 break;
10151 case BO_Add:
10152 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
10153 break;
10154 case BO_Sub:
10155 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
10156 break;
10157 case BO_Shl:
10158 case BO_Shr:
10159 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
10160 break;
10161 case BO_LE:
10162 case BO_LT:
10163 case BO_GE:
10164 case BO_GT:
10165 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true);
10166 break;
10167 case BO_EQ:
10168 case BO_NE:
10169 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, false);
10170 break;
10171 case BO_And:
10172 checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
10173 case BO_Xor:
10174 case BO_Or:
10175 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
10176 break;
10177 case BO_LAnd:
10178 case BO_LOr:
10179 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc);
10180 break;
10181 case BO_MulAssign:
10182 case BO_DivAssign:
10183 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true,
10184 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
10185 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
10186 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10187 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10188 break;
10189 case BO_RemAssign:
10190 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true);
10191 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
10192 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10193 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10194 break;
10195 case BO_AddAssign:
10196 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy);
10197 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10198 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10199 break;
10200 case BO_SubAssign:
10201 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
10202 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10203 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10204 break;
10205 case BO_ShlAssign:
10206 case BO_ShrAssign:
10207 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true);
10208 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
10209 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10210 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10211 break;
10212 case BO_AndAssign:
10213 case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough
10214 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc);
10215 case BO_XorAssign:
10216 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true);
10217 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
10218 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid())
10219 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
10220 break;
10221 case BO_Comma:
10222 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc);
10223 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) {
10224 VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind();
10225 OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind();
10226 }
10227 break;
10228 }
10229 if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid())
10230 return ExprError();
10231
10232 // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator
10233 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get());
10234 CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get());
10235
10236 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
10237 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope,
10238 &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"),
10239 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName);
10240 if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) {
10241 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getLocEnd());
10242 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) <<
10243 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getLocStart(), "object_setClass(") <<
10244 FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc), ",") <<
10245 FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")");
10246 }
10247 else
10248 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign);
10249 }
10250 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE =
10251 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()))
10252 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get());
10253
10254 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
10255 return new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK,
10256 OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
10257 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() !=
10258 OK_ObjCProperty) {
10259 VK = VK_LValue;
10260 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind();
10261 }
10262 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(
10263 LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
10264 OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
10265 }
10266
10267 /// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
10268 /// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
10269 /// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
10270 /// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema & Self,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)10271 static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10272 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
10273 Expr *RHSExpr) {
10274 BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr);
10275 BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr);
10276
10277 // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator.
10278 bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp();
10279 bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp();
10280 if (!isLeftComp && !isRightComp)
10281 return;
10282
10283 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
10284 // Don't diagnose this.
10285 bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp();
10286 bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp();
10287 if ((isLeftComp || isLeftBitwise) && (isRightComp || isRightBitwise))
10288 return;
10289
10290 SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(),
10291 OpLoc)
10292 : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getLocEnd());
10293 StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr();
10294 SourceRange ParensRange = isLeftComp ?
10295 SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getLocStart(), RHSExpr->getLocEnd())
10296 : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getLocStart(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getLocEnd());
10297
10298 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
10299 << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr;
10300 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
10301 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr,
10302 (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange());
10303 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
10304 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
10305 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
10306 ParensRange);
10307 }
10308
10309 /// \brief It accepts a '&' expr that is inside a '|' one.
10310 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&' expression
10311 /// in parentheses.
10312 static void
EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema & Self,SourceLocation OpLoc,BinaryOperator * Bop)10313 EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10314 BinaryOperator *Bop) {
10315 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And);
10316 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_and_in_bitwise_or)
10317 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
10318 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
10319 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
10320 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(),
10321 Bop->getSourceRange());
10322 }
10323
10324 /// \brief It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one.
10325 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression
10326 /// in parentheses.
10327 static void
EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema & Self,SourceLocation OpLoc,BinaryOperator * Bop)10328 EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10329 BinaryOperator *Bop) {
10330 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd);
10331 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or)
10332 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc;
10333 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
10334 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
10335 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(),
10336 Bop->getSourceRange());
10337 }
10338
10339 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
10340 /// 'true'.
EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema & S,Expr * E)10341 static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
10342 bool Res;
10343 return !E->isValueDependent() &&
10344 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res;
10345 }
10346
10347 /// \brief Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant
10348 /// 'false'.
EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema & S,Expr * E)10349 static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
10350 bool Res;
10351 return !E->isValueDependent() &&
10352 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res;
10353 }
10354
10355 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr.
DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema & S,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)10356 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10357 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10358 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) {
10359 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
10360 // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
10361 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr))
10362 return;
10363 // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
10364 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS()))
10365 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
10366 } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) {
10367 if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) {
10368 // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for
10369 // "a || b && 1", but warn now.
10370 if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS()))
10371 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop);
10372 }
10373 }
10374 }
10375 }
10376
10377 /// \brief Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr.
DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema & S,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)10378 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10379 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10380 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) {
10381 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) {
10382 // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
10383 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr))
10384 return;
10385 // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter.
10386 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS()))
10387 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
10388 }
10389 }
10390 }
10391
10392 /// \brief Look for '&' in the left or right hand of a '|' expr.
DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema & S,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * OrArg)10393 static void DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10394 Expr *OrArg) {
10395 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(OrArg)) {
10396 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_And)
10397 return EmitDiagnosticForBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(S, OpLoc, Bop);
10398 }
10399 }
10400
DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema & S,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * SubExpr,StringRef Shift)10401 static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10402 Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) {
10403 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) {
10404 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) {
10405 StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr();
10406 S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift)
10407 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op;
10408 SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(),
10409 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op,
10410 Bop->getSourceRange());
10411 }
10412 }
10413 }
10414
DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema & S,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)10415 static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10416 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10417 CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr);
10418 if (!OCE)
10419 return;
10420
10421 FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee();
10422 if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator())
10423 return;
10424
10425 OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator();
10426 if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater)
10427 return;
10428
10429 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison)
10430 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange()
10431 << (Kind == OO_LessLess);
10432 SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(),
10433 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence)
10434 << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"),
10435 OCE->getSourceRange());
10436 SuggestParentheses(S, OpLoc,
10437 S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first),
10438 SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getLocStart(),
10439 RHSExpr->getLocEnd()));
10440 }
10441
10442 /// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
10443 /// precedence.
DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema & Self,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)10444 static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10445 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr,
10446 Expr *RHSExpr){
10447 // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
10448 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
10449 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10450
10451 // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3"
10452 if (Opc == BO_Or && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
10453 DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr);
10454 DiagnoseBitwiseAndInBitwiseOr(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr);
10455 }
10456
10457 // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
10458 // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe.
10459 if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) {
10460 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10461 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10462 }
10463
10464 if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext()))
10465 || Opc == BO_Shr) {
10466 StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc);
10467 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift);
10468 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift);
10469 }
10470
10471 // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as:
10472 // cout << 5 == 4;
10473 if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc))
10474 DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10475 }
10476
10477 // Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
ActOnBinOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation TokLoc,tok::TokenKind Kind,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)10478 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
10479 tok::TokenKind Kind,
10480 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10481 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
10482 assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
10483 assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
10484
10485 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
10486 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10487
10488 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10489 }
10490
10491 /// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope.
BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema & S,Scope * Sc,SourceLocation OpLoc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,Expr * LHS,Expr * RHS)10492 static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10493 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10494 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
10495 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
10496 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
10497 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
10498 // the arguments.
10499 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
10500 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp
10501 = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10502 if (Sc && OverOp != OO_None && OverOp != OO_Equal)
10503 S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, Sc, LHS->getType(),
10504 RHS->getType(), Functions);
10505
10506 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
10507 // binary operation.
10508 return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS);
10509 }
10510
BuildBinOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation OpLoc,BinaryOperatorKind Opc,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr)10511 ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10512 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
10513 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) {
10514 // We want to end up calling one of checkPseudoObjectAssignment
10515 // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if
10516 // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent),
10517 // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case). We also want to get
10518 // any placeholder types out of the way.
10519
10520 // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS.
10521 if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
10522 // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis.
10523 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject &&
10524 BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc))
10525 return checkPseudoObjectAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10526
10527 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable.
10528 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
10529 // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder,
10530 // though. Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that
10531 // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set. Note
10532 // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never
10533 // instantiates to having an overloadable type.
10534 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr);
10535 if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10536 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get();
10537
10538 if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() ||
10539 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10540 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10541 }
10542
10543 ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr);
10544 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10545 LHSExpr = LHS.get();
10546 }
10547
10548 // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS.
10549 if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
10550 // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type
10551 // being assigned to.
10552 if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
10553 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent())
10554 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10555
10556 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10557 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10558
10559 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10560 }
10561
10562 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable.
10563 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload &&
10564 LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10565 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10566
10567 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr);
10568 if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError();
10569 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get();
10570 }
10571
10572 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10573 // If either expression is type-dependent, always build an
10574 // overloaded op.
10575 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent())
10576 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10577
10578 // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression has an
10579 // overloadable type.
10580 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
10581 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())
10582 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10583 }
10584
10585 // Build a built-in binary operation.
10586 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr);
10587 }
10588
CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,UnaryOperatorKind Opc,Expr * InputExpr)10589 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
10590 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
10591 Expr *InputExpr) {
10592 ExprResult Input = InputExpr;
10593 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
10594 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
10595 QualType resultType;
10596 switch (Opc) {
10597 case UO_PreInc:
10598 case UO_PreDec:
10599 case UO_PostInc:
10600 case UO_PostDec:
10601 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OK,
10602 OpLoc,
10603 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
10604 Opc == UO_PostInc,
10605 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
10606 Opc == UO_PreDec);
10607 break;
10608 case UO_AddrOf:
10609 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
10610 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, InputExpr);
10611 break;
10612 case UO_Deref: {
10613 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get());
10614 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10615 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc);
10616 break;
10617 }
10618 case UO_Plus:
10619 case UO_Minus:
10620 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get());
10621 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10622 resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10623 if (resultType->isDependentType())
10624 break;
10625 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1
10626 break;
10627 else if (resultType->isVectorType() &&
10628 // The z vector extensions don't allow + or - with bool vectors.
10629 (!Context.getLangOpts().ZVector ||
10630 resultType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() !=
10631 VectorType::AltiVecBool))
10632 break;
10633 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
10634 Opc == UO_Plus &&
10635 resultType->isPointerType())
10636 break;
10637
10638 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10639 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10640
10641 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
10642 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get());
10643 if (Input.isInvalid())
10644 return ExprError();
10645 resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10646 if (resultType->isDependentType())
10647 break;
10648 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
10649 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
10650 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
10651 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
10652 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange();
10653 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
10654 break;
10655 else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) {
10656 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
10657 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate
10658 // on vector float types.
10659 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
10660 if (!T->isIntegerType())
10661 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10662 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10663 }
10664 break;
10665 } else {
10666 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10667 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10668 }
10669 break;
10670
10671 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
10672 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
10673 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get());
10674 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10675 resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10676
10677 // Though we still have to promote half FP to float...
10678 if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) {
10679 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get();
10680 resultType = Context.FloatTy;
10681 }
10682
10683 if (resultType->isDependentType())
10684 break;
10685 if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) {
10686 // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough;
10687 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10688 // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9:
10689 // operand contextually converted to bool.
10690 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy,
10691 ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType));
10692 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
10693 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
10694 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not
10695 // operate on scalar float types.
10696 if (!resultType->isIntegerType())
10697 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10698 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10699 }
10700 } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) {
10701 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
10702 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) {
10703 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not
10704 // operate on vector float types.
10705 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
10706 if (!T->isIntegerType())
10707 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10708 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10709 }
10710 // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type.
10711 resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType);
10712 break;
10713 } else {
10714 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
10715 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange());
10716 }
10717
10718 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
10719 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
10720 resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType();
10721 break;
10722 case UO_Real:
10723 case UO_Imag:
10724 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
10725 // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps ordinary
10726 // complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to r-values.
10727 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10728 if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) {
10729 if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue &&
10730 Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary)
10731 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
10732 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10733 // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not.
10734 Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get());
10735 }
10736 break;
10737 case UO_Extension:
10738 resultType = Input.get()->getType();
10739 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind();
10740 OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind();
10741 break;
10742 }
10743 if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid())
10744 return ExprError();
10745
10746 // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator,
10747 // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially
10748 // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize]
10749 // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard).
10750 if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref)
10751 CheckArrayAccess(Input.get());
10752
10753 return new (Context)
10754 UnaryOperator(Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK, OpLoc);
10755 }
10756
10757 /// \brief Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member
10758 /// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member
10759 /// with the address-of operator.
isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr * E)10760 static bool isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) {
10761 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
10762 if (!DRE->getQualifier())
10763 return false;
10764
10765 ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl();
10766 if (!VD->isCXXClassMember())
10767 return false;
10768
10769 if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
10770 return true;
10771 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD))
10772 return Method->isInstance();
10773
10774 return false;
10775 }
10776
10777 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
10778 if (!ULE->getQualifier())
10779 return false;
10780
10781 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator D = ULE->decls_begin(),
10782 DEnd = ULE->decls_end();
10783 D != DEnd; ++D) {
10784 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(*D)) {
10785 if (Method->isInstance())
10786 return true;
10787 } else {
10788 // Overload set does not contain methods.
10789 break;
10790 }
10791 }
10792
10793 return false;
10794 }
10795
10796 return false;
10797 }
10798
BuildUnaryOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation OpLoc,UnaryOperatorKind Opc,Expr * Input)10799 ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10800 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) {
10801 // First things first: handle placeholders so that the
10802 // overloaded-operator check considers the right type.
10803 if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
10804 // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references.
10805 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject &&
10806 UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc))
10807 return checkPseudoObjectIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10808
10809 // extension is always a builtin operator.
10810 if (Opc == UO_Extension)
10811 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10812
10813 // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder.
10814 // The builtin code knows what to do.
10815 if (Opc == UO_AddrOf &&
10816 (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload ||
10817 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny ||
10818 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember))
10819 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10820
10821 // Anything else needs to be handled now.
10822 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input);
10823 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
10824 Input = Result.get();
10825 }
10826
10827 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
10828 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None &&
10829 !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) {
10830 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
10831 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
10832 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
10833 // the arguments.
10834 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
10835 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
10836 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
10837 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
10838 Functions);
10839
10840 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
10841 }
10842
10843 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
10844 }
10845
10846 // Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
ActOnUnaryOp(Scope * S,SourceLocation OpLoc,tok::TokenKind Op,Expr * Input)10847 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
10848 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
10849 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
10850 }
10851
10852 /// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,SourceLocation LabLoc,LabelDecl * TheDecl)10853 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc,
10854 LabelDecl *TheDecl) {
10855 TheDecl->markUsed(Context);
10856 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
10857 return new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl,
10858 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy));
10859 }
10860
10861 /// Given the last statement in a statement-expression, check whether
10862 /// the result is a producing expression (like a call to an
10863 /// ns_returns_retained function) and, if so, rebuild it to hoist the
10864 /// release out of the full-expression. Otherwise, return null.
10865 /// Cannot fail.
maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(Stmt * Statement)10866 static Expr *maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(Stmt *Statement) {
10867 // Should always be wrapped with one of these.
10868 ExprWithCleanups *cleanups = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Statement);
10869 if (!cleanups) return nullptr;
10870
10871 ImplicitCastExpr *cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(cleanups->getSubExpr());
10872 if (!cast || cast->getCastKind() != CK_ARCConsumeObject)
10873 return nullptr;
10874
10875 // Splice out the cast. This shouldn't modify any interesting
10876 // features of the statement.
10877 Expr *producer = cast->getSubExpr();
10878 assert(producer->getType() == cast->getType());
10879 assert(producer->getValueKind() == cast->getValueKind());
10880 cleanups->setSubExpr(producer);
10881 return cleanups;
10882 }
10883
ActOnStartStmtExpr()10884 void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() {
10885 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
10886 }
10887
ActOnStmtExprError()10888 void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() {
10889 // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a
10890 // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything.
10891
10892 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
10893 PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
10894 }
10895
10896 ExprResult
ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc,Stmt * SubStmt,SourceLocation RPLoc)10897 Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
10898 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
10899 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
10900 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
10901
10902 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
10903 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
10904 assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!");
10905 PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
10906
10907 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
10908 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
10909 // More semantic analysis is needed.
10910
10911 // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
10912 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
10913 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
10914 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
10915 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
10916 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
10917 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = nullptr;
10918 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
10919 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
10920 LastLabelStmt = Label;
10921 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
10922 }
10923
10924 if (Expr *LastE = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
10925 // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not
10926 // lvalue-to-rvalue. However, initialize an unqualified type.
10927 ExprResult LastExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(LastE);
10928 if (LastExpr.isInvalid())
10929 return ExprError();
10930 Ty = LastExpr.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
10931
10932 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr.get()->isTypeDependent()) {
10933 // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice
10934 // the consume out and bind it later. In the alternate case
10935 // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result
10936 // initialization will create a produce. In both cases the
10937 // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with
10938 // a bind.
10939 if (Expr *rebuiltLastStmt
10940 = maybeRebuildARCConsumingStmt(LastExpr.get())) {
10941 LastExpr = rebuiltLastStmt;
10942 } else {
10943 LastExpr = PerformCopyInitialization(
10944 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
10945 Ty,
10946 false),
10947 SourceLocation(),
10948 LastExpr);
10949 }
10950
10951 if (LastExpr.isInvalid())
10952 return ExprError();
10953 if (LastExpr.get() != nullptr) {
10954 if (!LastLabelStmt)
10955 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr.get());
10956 else
10957 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr.get());
10958 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
10959 }
10960 }
10961 }
10962 }
10963
10964 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
10965 // expressions are not lvalues.
10966 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
10967 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
10968 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
10969 return ResStmtExpr;
10970 }
10971
BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,TypeSourceInfo * TInfo,OffsetOfComponent * CompPtr,unsigned NumComponents,SourceLocation RParenLoc)10972 ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
10973 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
10974 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
10975 unsigned NumComponents,
10976 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
10977 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
10978 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
10979 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
10980
10981 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
10982 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
10983 // a struct/union/class.
10984 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
10985 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
10986 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
10987
10988 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
10989 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
10990 if (!Dependent
10991 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
10992 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange))
10993 return ExprError();
10994
10995 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
10996 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
10997 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
10998 // a system header!
10999 if (NumComponents != 1)
11000 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
11001 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
11002
11003 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
11004 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
11005 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
11006 SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
11007 SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
11008 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
11009 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
11010 if (OC.isBrackets) {
11011 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
11012 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
11013 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
11014 if(!AT)
11015 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
11016 << CurrentType);
11017 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
11018 } else
11019 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
11020
11021 ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E));
11022 if (IdxRval.isInvalid())
11023 return ExprError();
11024 Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get();
11025
11026 // The expression must be an integral expression.
11027 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
11028 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
11029 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
11030 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
11031 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
11032 << Idx->getSourceRange());
11033
11034 // Record this array index.
11035 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
11036 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
11037 continue;
11038 }
11039
11040 // Offset of a field.
11041 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
11042 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
11043 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
11044 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
11045 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
11046 continue;
11047 }
11048
11049 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
11050 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
11051 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
11052 return ExprError();
11053
11054 // Look for the designated field.
11055 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
11056 if (!RC)
11057 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
11058 << CurrentType);
11059 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
11060
11061 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
11062 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
11063 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
11064 // (clause 9).
11065 // C++11 [support.types]p4:
11066 // If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are
11067 // undefined.
11068 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
11069 bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD();
11070 unsigned DiagID =
11071 LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::ext_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type
11072 : diag::ext_offsetof_non_pod_type;
11073
11074 if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
11075 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, nullptr,
11076 PDiag(DiagID)
11077 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
11078 << CurrentType))
11079 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
11080 }
11081
11082 // Look for the field.
11083 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
11084 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
11085 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
11086 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr;
11087 if (!MemberDecl) {
11088 if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>()))
11089 MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField();
11090 }
11091
11092 if (!MemberDecl)
11093 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
11094 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
11095 OC.LocEnd));
11096
11097 // C99 7.17p3:
11098 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
11099 //
11100 // We diagnose this as an error.
11101 if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) {
11102 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
11103 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
11104 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
11105 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
11106 return ExprError();
11107 }
11108
11109 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
11110 if (IndirectMemberDecl)
11111 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext());
11112
11113 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
11114 // the base class indirections.
11115 CXXBasePaths Paths;
11116 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
11117 if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
11118 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base)
11119 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
11120 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
11121 return ExprError();
11122 }
11123
11124 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
11125 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
11126 B != BEnd; ++B)
11127 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
11128 }
11129
11130 if (IndirectMemberDecl) {
11131 for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) {
11132 assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI));
11133 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart,
11134 cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd));
11135 }
11136 } else
11137 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
11138
11139 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
11140 }
11141
11142 return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo,
11143 Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc);
11144 }
11145
ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope * S,SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,SourceLocation TypeLoc,ParsedType ParsedArgTy,OffsetOfComponent * CompPtr,unsigned NumComponents,SourceLocation RParenLoc)11146 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
11147 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
11148 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
11149 ParsedType ParsedArgTy,
11150 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
11151 unsigned NumComponents,
11152 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
11153
11154 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
11155 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo);
11156 if (ArgTy.isNull())
11157 return ExprError();
11158
11159 if (!ArgTInfo)
11160 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
11161
11162 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
11163 RParenLoc);
11164 }
11165
11166
ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,Expr * CondExpr,Expr * LHSExpr,Expr * RHSExpr,SourceLocation RPLoc)11167 ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
11168 Expr *CondExpr,
11169 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
11170 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
11171 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
11172
11173 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue;
11174 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary;
11175 QualType resType;
11176 bool ValueDependent = false;
11177 bool CondIsTrue = false;
11178 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
11179 resType = Context.DependentTy;
11180 ValueDependent = true;
11181 } else {
11182 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
11183 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
11184 ExprResult CondICE
11185 = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(CondExpr, &condEval,
11186 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant, false);
11187 if (CondICE.isInvalid())
11188 return ExprError();
11189 CondExpr = CondICE.get();
11190 CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue();
11191
11192 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
11193 Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr;
11194
11195 resType = ActiveExpr->getType();
11196 ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent();
11197 VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind();
11198 OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind();
11199 }
11200
11201 return new (Context)
11202 ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, resType, VK, OK, RPLoc,
11203 CondIsTrue, resType->isDependentType(), ValueDependent);
11204 }
11205
11206 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11207 // Clang Extensions.
11208 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
11209
11210 /// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc,Scope * CurScope)11211 void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
11212 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
11213
11214 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) {
11215 Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
11216 if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx =
11217 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext(),
11218 ManglingContextDecl)) {
11219 unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block);
11220 Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl);
11221 }
11222 }
11223
11224 PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block);
11225 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
11226 if (CurScope)
11227 PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block);
11228 else
11229 CurContext = Block;
11230
11231 getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true;
11232
11233 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any
11234 // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression.
11235 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(PotentiallyEvaluated);
11236 }
11237
ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc,Declarator & ParamInfo,Scope * CurScope)11238 void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo,
11239 Scope *CurScope) {
11240 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr &&
11241 "block-id should have no identifier!");
11242 assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == Declarator::BlockLiteralContext);
11243 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
11244
11245 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
11246 QualType T = Sig->getType();
11247
11248 // FIXME: We should allow unexpanded parameter packs here, but that would,
11249 // in turn, make the block expression contain unexpanded parameter packs.
11250 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block)) {
11251 // Drop the parameters.
11252 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
11253 EPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
11254 EPI.TypeQuals |= DeclSpec::TQ_const;
11255 T = Context.getFunctionType(Context.DependentTy, None, EPI);
11256 Sig = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
11257 }
11258
11259 // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block
11260 // literal signature. Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType
11261 // unless the function was written with a typedef.
11262 assert(T->isFunctionType() &&
11263 "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature");
11264
11265 // Look for an explicit signature in that function type.
11266 FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature;
11267
11268 TypeLoc tmp = Sig->getTypeLoc().IgnoreParens();
11269 if ((ExplicitSignature = tmp.getAs<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) {
11270
11271 // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by
11272 // GetTypeForDeclarator. If so, don't save that as part of the
11273 // written signature.
11274 if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() ==
11275 ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) {
11276 // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of
11277 // TypeSourceInfos.
11278 TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc();
11279 unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize();
11280 Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size);
11281 Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size);
11282
11283 ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc();
11284 }
11285 }
11286
11287 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
11288 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
11289
11290 const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>();
11291 QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType();
11292 bool isVariadic =
11293 (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic());
11294
11295 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
11296
11297 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
11298 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
11299 // ^ * { ... }
11300 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
11301 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) {
11302 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
11303 CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false);
11304 CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false;
11305 }
11306
11307 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
11308 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
11309 if (ExplicitSignature) {
11310 for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) {
11311 ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I);
11312 if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr &&
11313 !Param->isImplicit() &&
11314 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
11315 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
11316 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
11317 Params.push_back(Param);
11318 }
11319
11320 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
11321 // ^ fntype { ... }
11322 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
11323 for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) {
11324 ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(
11325 CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getLocStart(), I);
11326 Params.push_back(Param);
11327 }
11328 }
11329
11330 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
11331 if (!Params.empty()) {
11332 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params);
11333 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
11334 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
11335 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
11336 }
11337
11338 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
11339 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
11340
11341 // Put the parameter variables in scope.
11342 for (auto AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->params()) {
11343 AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
11344
11345 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
11346 if (AI->getIdentifier()) {
11347 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI);
11348
11349 PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
11350 }
11351 }
11352 }
11353
11354 /// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
11355 /// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc,Scope * CurScope)11356 void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
11357 // Leave the expression-evaluation context.
11358 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
11359 PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
11360
11361 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
11362 PopDeclContext();
11363 PopFunctionScopeInfo();
11364 }
11365
11366 /// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
11367 /// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,Stmt * Body,Scope * CurScope)11368 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
11369 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
11370 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
11371 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
11372 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
11373
11374 // Leave the expression-evaluation context.
11375 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction())
11376 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
11377 assert(!ExprNeedsCleanups && "cleanups within block not correctly bound!");
11378 PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
11379
11380 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
11381
11382 if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType)
11383 deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI);
11384
11385 PopDeclContext();
11386
11387 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
11388 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
11389 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
11390
11391 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
11392 QualType BlockTy;
11393
11394 // Set the captured variables on the block.
11395 // FIXME: Share capture structure between BlockDecl and CapturingScopeInfo!
11396 SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures;
11397 for (unsigned i = 0, e = BSI->Captures.size(); i != e; i++) {
11398 CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = BSI->Captures[i];
11399 if (Cap.isThisCapture())
11400 continue;
11401 BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Cap.getVariable(), Cap.isBlockCapture(),
11402 Cap.isNested(), Cap.getInitExpr());
11403 Captures.push_back(NewCap);
11404 }
11405 BSI->TheDecl->setCaptures(Context, Captures.begin(), Captures.end(),
11406 BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0);
11407
11408 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
11409 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
11410 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
11411
11412 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
11413 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
11414
11415 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
11416 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
11417 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
11418 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
11419 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI);
11420
11421 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
11422 // preserve its sugar structure.
11423 } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy &&
11424 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
11425 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
11426
11427 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
11428 } else {
11429 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
11430 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
11431 EPI.TypeQuals = 0; // FIXME: silently?
11432 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext;
11433 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
11434 }
11435
11436 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
11437 } else {
11438 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
11439 EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn);
11440 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI);
11441 }
11442
11443 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
11444 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
11445 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
11446
11447 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
11448 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() &&
11449 !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled())
11450 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
11451
11452 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
11453
11454 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again
11455 // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around
11456 // to deduce an implicit return type.
11457 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() &&
11458 !BSI->TheDecl->isDependentContext())
11459 computeNRVO(Body, BSI);
11460
11461 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy);
11462 AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
11463 PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, Result->getBlockDecl(), Result);
11464
11465 // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at
11466 // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context:
11467 if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) {
11468 // First, this expression has a new cleanup object.
11469 ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl());
11470 ExprNeedsCleanups = true;
11471
11472 // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured
11473 // variables needs destruction.
11474 for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) {
11475 const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable();
11476 if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) {
11477 getCurFunction()->setHasBranchProtectedScope();
11478 break;
11479 }
11480 }
11481 }
11482
11483 return Result;
11484 }
11485
ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,Expr * E,ParsedType Ty,SourceLocation RPLoc)11486 ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
11487 Expr *E, ParsedType Ty,
11488 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
11489 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
11490 GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
11491 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc);
11492 }
11493
BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,Expr * E,TypeSourceInfo * TInfo,SourceLocation RPLoc)11494 ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
11495 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
11496 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
11497 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
11498
11499 // Get the va_list type
11500 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
11501 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
11502 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
11503 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
11504 // a pointer for va_arg.
11505 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
11506 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
11507 ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E);
11508 if (Result.isInvalid())
11509 return ExprError();
11510 E = Result.get();
11511 } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
11512 // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode,
11513 // check the argument using reference binding.
11514 InitializedEntity Entity
11515 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11516 Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false);
11517 ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E);
11518 if (Init.isInvalid())
11519 return ExprError();
11520 E = Init.getAs<Expr>();
11521 } else {
11522 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
11523 // it is modified by va_arg.
11524 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
11525 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
11526 return ExprError();
11527 }
11528
11529 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
11530 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
11531 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
11532 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
11533 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
11534 }
11535
11536 if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) {
11537 if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(),
11538 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete,
11539 TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
11540 return ExprError();
11541
11542 if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
11543 TInfo->getType(),
11544 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract,
11545 TInfo->getTypeLoc()))
11546 return ExprError();
11547
11548 if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) {
11549 Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
11550 TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType()
11551 ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified
11552 : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod)
11553 << TInfo->getType()
11554 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
11555 }
11556
11557 // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted
11558 // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior).
11559 QualType PromoteType;
11560 if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
11561 PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType());
11562 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType()))
11563 PromoteType = QualType();
11564 }
11565 if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
11566 PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy;
11567 if (!PromoteType.isNull())
11568 DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E,
11569 PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible)
11570 << TInfo->getType()
11571 << PromoteType
11572 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange());
11573 }
11574
11575 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11576 return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T);
11577 }
11578
ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc)11579 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
11580 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
11581 // pointers on the target.
11582 QualType Ty;
11583 unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0);
11584 if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth())
11585 Ty = Context.IntTy;
11586 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())
11587 Ty = Context.LongTy;
11588 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth())
11589 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
11590 else {
11591 llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!");
11592 }
11593
11594 return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc);
11595 }
11596
11597 bool
ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType,Expr * & Exp)11598 Sema::ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType, Expr *&Exp) {
11599 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
11600 return false;
11601
11602 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
11603 if (!PT)
11604 return false;
11605
11606 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
11607 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
11608 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
11609 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
11610 return false;
11611 }
11612
11613 // Ignore any parens, implicit casts (should only be
11614 // array-to-pointer decays), and not-so-opaque values. The last is
11615 // important for making this trigger for property assignments.
11616 Expr *SrcExpr = Exp->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11617 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OV = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(SrcExpr))
11618 if (OV->getSourceExpr())
11619 SrcExpr = OV->getSourceExpr()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11620
11621 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr);
11622 if (!SL || !SL->isAscii())
11623 return false;
11624 Diag(SL->getLocStart(), diag::err_missing_atsign_prefix)
11625 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
11626 Exp = BuildObjCStringLiteral(SL->getLocStart(), SL).get();
11627 return true;
11628 }
11629
DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,SourceLocation Loc,QualType DstType,QualType SrcType,Expr * SrcExpr,AssignmentAction Action,bool * Complained)11630 bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
11631 SourceLocation Loc,
11632 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
11633 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
11634 bool *Complained) {
11635 if (Complained)
11636 *Complained = false;
11637
11638 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
11639 bool CheckInferredResultType = false;
11640 bool isInvalid = false;
11641 unsigned DiagKind = 0;
11642 FixItHint Hint;
11643 ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints;
11644 bool MayHaveConvFixit = false;
11645 bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false;
11646 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr;
11647 const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr;
11648
11649 switch (ConvTy) {
11650 case Compatible:
11651 DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr);
11652 return false;
11653
11654 case PointerToInt:
11655 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
11656 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11657 MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11658 break;
11659 case IntToPointer:
11660 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
11661 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11662 MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11663 break;
11664 case IncompatiblePointer:
11665 DiagKind =
11666 (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited ?
11667 diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer :
11668 diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer);
11669 CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
11670 SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType();
11671 if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) {
11672 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11673 }
11674 else if (CheckInferredResultType) {
11675 SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType();
11676 DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType();
11677 }
11678 MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11679 break;
11680 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
11681 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
11682 break;
11683 case FunctionVoidPointer:
11684 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
11685 break;
11686 case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: {
11687 // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary.
11688 if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType);
11689
11690 Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
11691 Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers();
11692 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) {
11693 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space;
11694 break;
11695
11696
11697 } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) {
11698 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership;
11699 break;
11700 }
11701
11702 llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!");
11703 // fallthrough
11704 }
11705 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
11706 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
11707 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
11708 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
11709 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
11710 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
11711 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
11712 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
11713 // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for
11714 // C++ semantics.
11715 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
11716 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
11717 return false;
11718 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
11719 break;
11720 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
11721 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
11722 break;
11723 case IntToBlockPointer:
11724 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
11725 break;
11726 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
11727 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
11728 break;
11729 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: {
11730 if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
11731 const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT =
11732 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
11733 for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) {
11734 PDecl = srcProto;
11735 break;
11736 }
11737 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
11738 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType())
11739 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
11740 }
11741 else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
11742 const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT =
11743 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
11744 for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) {
11745 PDecl = dstProto;
11746 break;
11747 }
11748 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT =
11749 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType())
11750 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl();
11751 }
11752 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
11753 break;
11754 }
11755 case IncompatibleVectors:
11756 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
11757 break;
11758 case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef:
11759 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign;
11760 break;
11761 case Incompatible:
11762 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
11763 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this);
11764 MayHaveConvFixit = true;
11765 isInvalid = true;
11766 MayHaveFunctionDiff = true;
11767 break;
11768 }
11769
11770 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
11771 switch (Action) {
11772 case AA_Assigning:
11773 case AA_Initializing:
11774 // The destination type comes first.
11775 FirstType = DstType;
11776 SecondType = SrcType;
11777 break;
11778
11779 case AA_Returning:
11780 case AA_Passing:
11781 case AA_Passing_CFAudited:
11782 case AA_Converting:
11783 case AA_Sending:
11784 case AA_Casting:
11785 // The source type comes first.
11786 FirstType = SrcType;
11787 SecondType = DstType;
11788 break;
11789 }
11790
11791 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind);
11792 if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited)
11793 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << AA_Passing << SrcExpr->getSourceRange();
11794 else
11795 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange();
11796
11797 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
11798 assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull());
11799 if (!ConvHints.isNull()) {
11800 for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = ConvHints.Hints.begin(),
11801 HE = ConvHints.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
11802 FDiag << *HI;
11803 } else {
11804 FDiag << Hint;
11805 }
11806 if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); }
11807
11808 if (MayHaveFunctionDiff)
11809 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType);
11810
11811 Diag(Loc, FDiag);
11812 if (DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id &&
11813 PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition())
11814 Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::not_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id)
11815 << IFace->getName() << PDecl->getName();
11816
11817 if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy)
11818 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression,
11819 FirstType);
11820
11821 if (CheckInferredResultType)
11822 EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr);
11823
11824 if (Action == AA_Returning && ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer)
11825 EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType);
11826
11827 if (Complained)
11828 *Complained = true;
11829 return isInvalid;
11830 }
11831
VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr * E,llvm::APSInt * Result)11832 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E,
11833 llvm::APSInt *Result) {
11834 class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser {
11835 public:
11836 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override {
11837 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus << SR;
11838 }
11839 } Diagnoser;
11840
11841 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser);
11842 }
11843
VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr * E,llvm::APSInt * Result,unsigned DiagID,bool AllowFold)11844 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E,
11845 llvm::APSInt *Result,
11846 unsigned DiagID,
11847 bool AllowFold) {
11848 class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser {
11849 unsigned DiagID;
11850
11851 public:
11852 IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID)
11853 : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { }
11854
11855 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override {
11856 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << SR;
11857 }
11858 } Diagnoser(DiagID);
11859
11860 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, AllowFold);
11861 }
11862
diagnoseFold(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc,SourceRange SR)11863 void Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11864 SourceRange SR) {
11865 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << SR << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus;
11866 }
11867
11868 ExprResult
VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr * E,llvm::APSInt * Result,VerifyICEDiagnoser & Diagnoser,bool AllowFold)11869 Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result,
11870 VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser,
11871 bool AllowFold) {
11872 SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getLocStart();
11873
11874 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
11875 // C++11 [expr.const]p5:
11876 // If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an
11877 // integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall
11878 // have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or
11879 // unscoped enumeration type
11880 ExprResult Converted;
11881 class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser {
11882 public:
11883 CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(bool Silent)
11884 : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/false,
11885 Silent, true) {}
11886
11887 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
11888 QualType T) override {
11889 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral) << T;
11890 }
11891
11892 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete(
11893 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
11894 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T;
11895 }
11896
11897 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv(
11898 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override {
11899 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy;
11900 }
11901
11902 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv(
11903 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override {
11904 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here)
11905 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
11906 }
11907
11908 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous(
11909 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
11910 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T;
11911 }
11912
11913 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous(
11914 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override {
11915 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here)
11916 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
11917 }
11918
11919 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion(
11920 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override {
11921 llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted");
11922 }
11923 } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress);
11924
11925 Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E,
11926 ConvertDiagnoser);
11927 if (Converted.isInvalid())
11928 return Converted;
11929 E = Converted.get();
11930 if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
11931 return ExprError();
11932 } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) {
11933 // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type.
11934 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress)
11935 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
11936 return ExprError();
11937 }
11938
11939 // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice
11940 // in the non-ICE case.
11941 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) {
11942 if (Result)
11943 *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstInt(Context);
11944 return E;
11945 }
11946
11947 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
11948 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
11949 EvalResult.Diag = &Notes;
11950
11951 // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's
11952 // not a constant expression as a side-effect.
11953 bool Folded = E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context) &&
11954 EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects;
11955
11956 // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression
11957 // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then
11958 // this is a constant expression.
11959 if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) {
11960 if (Result)
11961 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
11962 return E;
11963 }
11964
11965 // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point
11966 // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially
11967 // redundant note.
11968 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
11969 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
11970 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first;
11971 Notes.clear();
11972 }
11973
11974 if (!Folded || !AllowFold) {
11975 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) {
11976 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
11977 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I)
11978 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
11979 }
11980
11981 return ExprError();
11982 }
11983
11984 Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange());
11985 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I)
11986 Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
11987
11988 if (Result)
11989 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
11990 return E;
11991 }
11992
11993 namespace {
11994 // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively
11995 // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated.
11996 class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> {
11997 typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform;
11998
11999 public:
TransformToPE(Sema & SemaRef)12000 TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { }
12001
12002 // Make sure we redo semantic analysis
AlwaysRebuild()12003 bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; }
12004
12005 // Make sure we handle LabelStmts correctly.
12006 // FIXME: This does the right thing, but maybe we need a more general
12007 // fix to TreeTransform?
TransformLabelStmt(LabelStmt * S)12008 StmtResult TransformLabelStmt(LabelStmt *S) {
12009 S->getDecl()->setStmt(nullptr);
12010 return BaseTransform::TransformLabelStmt(S);
12011 }
12012
12013 // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which
12014 // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming
12015 // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST.
12016 // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this
12017 // case?
12018 //
12019 // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls.
TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr * E)12020 ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
12021 if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) &&
12022 !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext())
12023 return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(),
12024 diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
12025 << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
12026
12027 return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E);
12028 }
12029
12030 // Exception: filter out member pointer formation
TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator * E)12031 ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) {
12032 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType())
12033 return E;
12034
12035 return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E);
12036 }
12037
TransformLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr * E)12038 ExprResult TransformLambdaExpr(LambdaExpr *E) {
12039 // Lambdas never need to be transformed.
12040 return E;
12041 }
12042 };
12043 }
12044
TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr * E)12045 ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) {
12046 assert(isUnevaluatedContext() &&
12047 "Should only transform unevaluated expressions");
12048 ExprEvalContexts.back().Context =
12049 ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context;
12050 if (isUnevaluatedContext())
12051 return E;
12052 return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E);
12053 }
12054
12055 void
PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,Decl * LambdaContextDecl,bool IsDecltype)12056 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,
12057 Decl *LambdaContextDecl,
12058 bool IsDecltype) {
12059 ExprEvalContexts.emplace_back(NewContext, ExprCleanupObjects.size(),
12060 ExprNeedsCleanups, LambdaContextDecl,
12061 IsDecltype);
12062 ExprNeedsCleanups = false;
12063 if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty())
12064 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
12065 }
12066
12067 void
PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t,bool IsDecltype)12068 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext,
12069 ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t,
12070 bool IsDecltype) {
12071 Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl;
12072 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, IsDecltype);
12073 }
12074
PopExpressionEvaluationContext()12075 void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
12076 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
12077 unsigned NumTypos = Rec.NumTypos;
12078
12079 if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) {
12080 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) {
12081 unsigned D;
12082 if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) {
12083 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2:
12084 // A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand
12085 // (Clause 5).
12086 D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand;
12087 } else {
12088 // C++1y [expr.const]p2:
12089 // A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the
12090 // evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would
12091 // evaluate [...] a lambda-expression.
12092 D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression;
12093 }
12094 for (const auto *L : Rec.Lambdas)
12095 Diag(L->getLocStart(), D);
12096 } else {
12097 // Mark the capture expressions odr-used. This was deferred
12098 // during lambda expression creation.
12099 for (auto *Lambda : Rec.Lambdas) {
12100 for (auto *C : Lambda->capture_inits())
12101 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(C);
12102 }
12103 }
12104 }
12105
12106 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
12107 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
12108 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
12109 // will never be constructed.
12110 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.Context == ConstantEvaluated) {
12111 ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects,
12112 ExprCleanupObjects.end());
12113 ExprNeedsCleanups = Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups;
12114 CleanupVarDeclMarking();
12115 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs);
12116 // Otherwise, merge the contexts together.
12117 } else {
12118 ExprNeedsCleanups |= Rec.ParentNeedsCleanups;
12119 MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.begin(),
12120 Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.end());
12121 }
12122
12123 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
12124 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
12125
12126 if (!ExprEvalContexts.empty())
12127 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumTypos += NumTypos;
12128 else
12129 assert(NumTypos == 0 && "There are outstanding typos after popping the "
12130 "last ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord");
12131 }
12132
DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext()12133 void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() {
12134 ExprCleanupObjects.erase(
12135 ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects,
12136 ExprCleanupObjects.end());
12137 ExprNeedsCleanups = false;
12138 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear();
12139 }
12140
HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr * E)12141 ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) {
12142 if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType())
12143 return E;
12144 return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E);
12145 }
12146
IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(Sema & SemaRef)12147 static bool IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(Sema &SemaRef) {
12148 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
12149 // an instantiation.
12150 if (SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext())
12151 return false;
12152
12153 switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
12154 case Sema::Unevaluated:
12155 case Sema::UnevaluatedAbstract:
12156 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
12157 // (Depending on how you read the standard, we actually do need to do
12158 // something here for null pointer constants, but the standard's
12159 // definition of a null pointer constant is completely crazy.)
12160 return false;
12161
12162 case Sema::ConstantEvaluated:
12163 case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluated:
12164 // We are in a potentially evaluated expression (or a constant-expression
12165 // in C++03); we need to do implicit template instantiation, implicitly
12166 // define class members, and mark most declarations as used.
12167 return true;
12168
12169 case Sema::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
12170 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
12171 // containing expression is used.
12172 return false;
12173 }
12174 llvm_unreachable("Invalid context");
12175 }
12176
12177 /// \brief Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used
12178 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3)
MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc,FunctionDecl * Func,bool OdrUse)12179 void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func,
12180 bool OdrUse) {
12181 assert(Func && "No function?");
12182
12183 Func->setReferenced();
12184
12185 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3:
12186 // A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is
12187 // odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a
12188 // set of overloaded functions [...].
12189 //
12190 // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we
12191 // can just check that here. Skip the rest of this function if we've already
12192 // marked the function as used.
12193 if (Func->isUsed(/*CheckUsedAttr=*/false) ||
12194 !IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(*this)) {
12195 // C++11 [temp.inst]p3:
12196 // Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly
12197 // instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template
12198 // specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is
12199 // referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist.
12200 //
12201 // We consider constexpr function templates to be referenced in a context
12202 // that requires a definition to exist whenever they are referenced.
12203 //
12204 // FIXME: This instantiates constexpr functions too frequently. If this is
12205 // really an unevaluated context (and we're not just in the definition of a
12206 // function template or overload resolution or other cases which we
12207 // incorrectly consider to be unevaluated contexts), and we're not in a
12208 // subexpression which we actually need to evaluate (for instance, a
12209 // template argument, array bound or an expression in a braced-init-list),
12210 // we are not permitted to instantiate this constexpr function definition.
12211 //
12212 // FIXME: This also implicitly defines special members too frequently. They
12213 // are only supposed to be implicitly defined if they are odr-used, but they
12214 // are not odr-used from constant expressions in unevaluated contexts.
12215 // However, they cannot be referenced if they are deleted, and they are
12216 // deleted whenever the implicit definition of the special member would
12217 // fail.
12218 if (!Func->isConstexpr() || Func->getBody())
12219 return;
12220 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func);
12221 if (!Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() && (!MD || MD->isUserProvided()))
12222 return;
12223 }
12224
12225 // Note that this declaration has been used.
12226 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
12227 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl());
12228 if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) {
12229 if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
12230 if (Constructor->isTrivial() && !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
12231 return;
12232 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
12233 } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) {
12234 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
12235 } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) {
12236 DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
12237 }
12238 } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) {
12239 DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
12240 }
12241 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor =
12242 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) {
12243 Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl());
12244 if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted()) {
12245 if (Destructor->isTrivial() && !Destructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
12246 return;
12247 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
12248 }
12249 if (Destructor->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext)
12250 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
12251 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) {
12252 if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
12253 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
12254 MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl());
12255 if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) {
12256 if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
12257 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
12258 else
12259 DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
12260 }
12261 } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) &&
12262 MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) {
12263 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
12264 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl());
12265 if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion())
12266 DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion);
12267 else
12268 DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion);
12269 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext)
12270 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
12271 }
12272
12273 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
12274 // FIXME: Is this really right?
12275 if (CurContext == Func) return;
12276
12277 // Resolve the exception specification for any function which is
12278 // used: CodeGen will need it.
12279 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
12280 if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()))
12281 ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT);
12282
12283 if (!OdrUse) return;
12284
12285 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
12286 // class templates.
12287 if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
12288 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
12289 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Loc;
12290 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
12291 = Func->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
12292 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
12293 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
12294 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
12295 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
12296 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
12297 PointOfInstantiation = SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation();
12298 }
12299 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
12300 = Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
12301 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
12302 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
12303 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
12304 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
12305 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
12306 PointOfInstantiation = MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation();
12307 }
12308 }
12309
12310 if (!AlreadyInstantiated || Func->isConstexpr()) {
12311 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) &&
12312 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() &&
12313 ActiveTemplateInstantiations.size())
12314 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(
12315 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation));
12316 else if (Func->isConstexpr())
12317 // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the
12318 // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a
12319 // call to such a function.
12320 InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func);
12321 else {
12322 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Func,
12323 PointOfInstantiation));
12324 // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated.
12325 Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func);
12326 }
12327 }
12328 } else {
12329 // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
12330 for (auto i : Func->redecls()) {
12331 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
12332 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i);
12333 }
12334 }
12335
12336 // Keep track of used but undefined functions.
12337 if (!Func->isDefined()) {
12338 if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func))
12339 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
12340 else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() &&
12341 !LangOpts.GNUInline &&
12342 !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>())
12343 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc));
12344 }
12345
12346 // Normally the most current decl is marked used while processing the use and
12347 // any subsequent decls are marked used by decl merging. This fails with
12348 // template instantiation since marking can happen at the end of the file
12349 // and, because of the two phase lookup, this function is called with at
12350 // decl in the middle of a decl chain. We loop to maintain the invariant
12351 // that once a decl is used, all decls after it are also used.
12352 for (FunctionDecl *F = Func->getMostRecentDecl();; F = F->getPreviousDecl()) {
12353 F->markUsed(Context);
12354 if (F == Func)
12355 break;
12356 }
12357 }
12358
12359 static void
diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema & S,SourceLocation loc,VarDecl * var,DeclContext * DC)12360 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc,
12361 VarDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) {
12362 DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext();
12363
12364 // If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then
12365 // we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of
12366 // the next.
12367 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) &&
12368 isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC))
12369 return;
12370
12371 // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code
12372 // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of
12373 // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later.
12374 //
12375 // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this
12376 // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound
12377 // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious.
12378 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
12379 return;
12380
12381 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) &&
12382 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) {
12383 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_lambda)
12384 << var->getIdentifier();
12385 } else if (FunctionDecl *fn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) {
12386 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
12387 << var->getIdentifier() << fn->getDeclName();
12388 } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) {
12389 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_block)
12390 << var->getIdentifier();
12391 } else {
12392 // FIXME: Is there any other context where a local variable can be
12393 // declared?
12394 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_context)
12395 << var->getIdentifier();
12396 }
12397
12398 S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
12399 << var->getIdentifier();
12400
12401 // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents
12402 // capture.
12403 }
12404
12405
isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo * CSI,VarDecl * Var,bool & SubCapturesAreNested,QualType & CaptureType,QualType & DeclRefType)12406 static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var,
12407 bool &SubCapturesAreNested,
12408 QualType &CaptureType,
12409 QualType &DeclRefType) {
12410 // Check whether we've already captured it.
12411 if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) {
12412 // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested.
12413 SubCapturesAreNested = true;
12414
12415 // Retrieve the capture type for this variable.
12416 CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType();
12417
12418 // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable.
12419 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12420
12421 const CapturingScopeInfo::Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var);
12422 if (Cap.isCopyCapture() &&
12423 !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) && cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Mutable))
12424 DeclRefType.addConst();
12425 return true;
12426 }
12427 return false;
12428 }
12429
12430 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can
12431 // capture; other scopes don't work.
getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext * DC,VarDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,const bool Diagnose,Sema & S)12432 static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC, VarDecl *Var,
12433 SourceLocation Loc,
12434 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) {
12435 if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC))
12436 return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC);
12437 else if (Var->hasLocalStorage()) {
12438 if (Diagnose)
12439 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, Loc, Var, DC);
12440 }
12441 return nullptr;
12442 }
12443
12444 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture
12445 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.)
12446 // so check for eligibility.
isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo * CSI,VarDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,const bool Diagnose,Sema & S)12447 static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var,
12448 SourceLocation Loc,
12449 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) {
12450
12451 bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI);
12452 bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
12453
12454 // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables
12455 // (e.g. anonymous unions).
12456 // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm
12457 // assuming that's the intent.
12458 if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) {
12459 if (Diagnose) {
12460 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var);
12461 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
12462 }
12463 return false;
12464 }
12465
12466 // Prohibit variably-modified types in blocks; they're difficult to deal with.
12467 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && IsBlock) {
12468 if (Diagnose) {
12469 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
12470 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12471 << Var->getDeclName();
12472 }
12473 return false;
12474 }
12475 // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too.
12476 // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct.
12477 if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
12478 if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
12479 if (Diagnose) {
12480 if (IsBlock)
12481 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type);
12482 else
12483 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type)
12484 << Var->getDeclName();
12485 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12486 << Var->getDeclName();
12487 }
12488 return false;
12489 }
12490 }
12491 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
12492 // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block
12493 // variables; they don't support the expected semantics.
12494 if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) {
12495 if (Diagnose) {
12496 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable)
12497 << Var->getDeclName() << !IsLambda;
12498 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12499 << Var->getDeclName();
12500 }
12501 return false;
12502 }
12503
12504 return true;
12505 }
12506
12507 // Returns true if the capture by block was successful.
captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo * BSI,VarDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,const bool BuildAndDiagnose,QualType & CaptureType,QualType & DeclRefType,const bool Nested,Sema & S)12508 static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, VarDecl *Var,
12509 SourceLocation Loc,
12510 const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
12511 QualType &CaptureType,
12512 QualType &DeclRefType,
12513 const bool Nested,
12514 Sema &S) {
12515 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr;
12516 bool ByRef = false;
12517
12518 // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays.
12519 if (CaptureType->isArrayType()) {
12520 if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12521 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
12522 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12523 << Var->getDeclName();
12524 }
12525 return false;
12526 }
12527
12528 // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables.
12529 if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
12530 if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12531 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture)
12532 << /*block*/ 0;
12533 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12534 << Var->getDeclName();
12535 }
12536 return false;
12537 }
12538 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>();
12539 if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType()) {
12540 // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or
12541 // declaration reference types.
12542 ByRef = true;
12543 } else {
12544 // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'.
12545 CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst();
12546 DeclRefType = CaptureType;
12547
12548 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BuildAndDiagnose) {
12549 if (const RecordType *Record = DeclRefType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
12550 // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it.
12551 // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have
12552 // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are
12553 // an exception because it's technically only the call site that
12554 // actually requires the destructor.
12555 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
12556 S.FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record);
12557
12558 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the copy
12559 // full-expression.
12560 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext scope(S, S.PotentiallyEvaluated);
12561
12562 // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from
12563 // the stack requires a const copy constructor. This is not true
12564 // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap.
12565 Expr *DeclRef = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, Nested,
12566 DeclRefType.withConst(),
12567 VK_LValue, Loc);
12568
12569 ExprResult Result
12570 = S.PerformCopyInitialization(
12571 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(),
12572 CaptureType, false),
12573 Loc, DeclRef);
12574
12575 // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization
12576 // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor. Recover from
12577 // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary.
12578 if (!Result.isInvalid() &&
12579 !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor()
12580 ->isTrivial()) {
12581 Result = S.MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result);
12582 CopyExpr = Result.get();
12583 }
12584 }
12585 }
12586 }
12587
12588 // Actually capture the variable.
12589 if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12590 BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc,
12591 SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr);
12592
12593 return true;
12594
12595 }
12596
12597
12598 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the captured region.
captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo * RSI,VarDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,const bool BuildAndDiagnose,QualType & CaptureType,QualType & DeclRefType,const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,Sema & S)12599 static bool captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI,
12600 VarDecl *Var,
12601 SourceLocation Loc,
12602 const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
12603 QualType &CaptureType,
12604 QualType &DeclRefType,
12605 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,
12606 Sema &S) {
12607
12608 // By default, capture variables by reference.
12609 bool ByRef = true;
12610 // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below).
12611 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && S.IsOpenMPCapturedVar(Var))
12612 DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType();
12613 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
12614 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr;
12615 if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12616 // The current implementation assumes that all variables are captured
12617 // by references. Since there is no capture by copy, no expression
12618 // evaluation will be needed.
12619 RecordDecl *RD = RSI->TheRecordDecl;
12620
12621 FieldDecl *Field
12622 = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, RD, Loc, Loc, nullptr, CaptureType,
12623 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CaptureType, Loc),
12624 nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit);
12625 Field->setImplicit(true);
12626 Field->setAccess(AS_private);
12627 RD->addDecl(Field);
12628
12629 CopyExpr = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Var, RefersToCapturedVariable,
12630 DeclRefType, VK_LValue, Loc);
12631 Var->setReferenced(true);
12632 Var->markUsed(S.Context);
12633 }
12634
12635 // Actually capture the variable.
12636 if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12637 RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, Loc,
12638 SourceLocation(), CaptureType, CopyExpr);
12639
12640
12641 return true;
12642 }
12643
12644 /// \brief Create a field within the lambda class for the variable
12645 /// being captured.
addAsFieldToClosureType(Sema & S,LambdaScopeInfo * LSI,VarDecl * Var,QualType FieldType,QualType DeclRefType,SourceLocation Loc,bool RefersToCapturedVariable)12646 static void addAsFieldToClosureType(Sema &S, LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, VarDecl *Var,
12647 QualType FieldType, QualType DeclRefType,
12648 SourceLocation Loc,
12649 bool RefersToCapturedVariable) {
12650 CXXRecordDecl *Lambda = LSI->Lambda;
12651
12652 // Build the non-static data member.
12653 FieldDecl *Field
12654 = FieldDecl::Create(S.Context, Lambda, Loc, Loc, nullptr, FieldType,
12655 S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FieldType, Loc),
12656 nullptr, false, ICIS_NoInit);
12657 Field->setImplicit(true);
12658 Field->setAccess(AS_private);
12659 Lambda->addDecl(Field);
12660 }
12661
12662 /// \brief Capture the given variable in the lambda.
captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo * LSI,VarDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,const bool BuildAndDiagnose,QualType & CaptureType,QualType & DeclRefType,const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind,SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,const bool IsTopScope,Sema & S)12663 static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI,
12664 VarDecl *Var,
12665 SourceLocation Loc,
12666 const bool BuildAndDiagnose,
12667 QualType &CaptureType,
12668 QualType &DeclRefType,
12669 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable,
12670 const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind,
12671 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,
12672 const bool IsTopScope,
12673 Sema &S) {
12674
12675 // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value.
12676 bool ByRef = false;
12677 if (IsTopScope && Kind != Sema::TryCapture_Implicit) {
12678 ByRef = (Kind == Sema::TryCapture_ExplicitByRef);
12679 } else {
12680 ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref);
12681 }
12682
12683 // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable.
12684 if (ByRef) {
12685 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15:
12686 // An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or
12687 // explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is
12688 // unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data
12689 // members are declared in the closure type for entities
12690 // captured by reference.
12691 //
12692 // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference
12693 // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears
12694 // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will
12695 // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and
12696 // easily defensible position.
12697 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
12698 } else {
12699 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14:
12700 // For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static
12701 // data member is declared in the closure type. The
12702 // declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type
12703 // of such a data member is the type of the corresponding
12704 // captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an
12705 // object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the
12706 // captured entity is a reference to a function, the
12707 // corresponding data member is also a reference to a
12708 // function. - end note ]
12709 if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){
12710 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
12711 CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType();
12712 }
12713
12714 // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables.
12715 if (CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
12716 if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12717 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1;
12718 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12719 << Var->getDeclName();
12720 }
12721 return false;
12722 }
12723
12724 // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type.
12725 if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12726 if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() &&
12727 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, CaptureType,
12728 diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_type,
12729 Var->getDeclName()))
12730 return false;
12731
12732 if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType,
12733 diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type))
12734 return false;
12735 }
12736 }
12737
12738 // Capture this variable in the lambda.
12739 if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12740 addAsFieldToClosureType(S, LSI, Var, CaptureType, DeclRefType, Loc,
12741 RefersToCapturedVariable);
12742
12743 // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable.
12744 if (ByRef)
12745 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12746 else {
12747 // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5:
12748 // The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline
12749 // function call operator [...]. This function call operator is
12750 // declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expression’s
12751 // parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable.
12752 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12753 if (!LSI->Mutable && !CaptureType->isReferenceType())
12754 DeclRefType.addConst();
12755 }
12756
12757 // Add the capture.
12758 if (BuildAndDiagnose)
12759 LSI->addCapture(Var, /*IsBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable,
12760 Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, /*CopyExpr=*/nullptr);
12761
12762 return true;
12763 }
12764
tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl * Var,SourceLocation ExprLoc,TryCaptureKind Kind,SourceLocation EllipsisLoc,bool BuildAndDiagnose,QualType & CaptureType,QualType & DeclRefType,const unsigned * const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt)12765 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(
12766 VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc, TryCaptureKind Kind,
12767 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType,
12768 QualType &DeclRefType, const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) {
12769 // An init-capture is notionally from the context surrounding its
12770 // declaration, but its parent DC is the lambda class.
12771 DeclContext *VarDC = Var->getDeclContext();
12772 if (Var->isInitCapture())
12773 VarDC = VarDC->getParent();
12774
12775 DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
12776 const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt
12777 ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
12778 // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the
12779 // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt
12780 if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) {
12781 unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1;
12782 while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) {
12783 DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC);
12784 --FSIndex;
12785 }
12786 }
12787
12788
12789 // If the variable is declared in the current context, there is no need to
12790 // capture it.
12791 if (VarDC == DC) return true;
12792
12793 // Capture global variables if it is required to use private copy of this
12794 // variable.
12795 bool IsGlobal = !Var->hasLocalStorage();
12796 if (IsGlobal && !(LangOpts.OpenMP && IsOpenMPCapturedVar(Var)))
12797 return true;
12798
12799 // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable,
12800 // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when
12801 // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing
12802 // capture of that variable. We start from the innermost capturing-entity
12803 // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities
12804 // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s
12805 // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured
12806 // the variable.
12807 CaptureType = Var->getType();
12808 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType();
12809 bool Nested = false;
12810 bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCapture_Implicit);
12811 unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex;
12812 unsigned OpenMPLevel = 0;
12813 do {
12814 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can
12815 // capture; other scopes don't work.
12816 DeclContext *ParentDC = getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var,
12817 ExprLoc,
12818 BuildAndDiagnose,
12819 *this);
12820 // We need to check for the parent *first* because, if we *have*
12821 // private-captured a global variable, we need to recursively capture it in
12822 // intermediate blocks, lambdas, etc.
12823 if (!ParentDC) {
12824 if (IsGlobal) {
12825 FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex - 1;
12826 break;
12827 }
12828 return true;
12829 }
12830
12831 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex];
12832 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI);
12833
12834
12835 // Check whether we've already captured it.
12836 if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType,
12837 DeclRefType))
12838 break;
12839 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP) {
12840 if (auto *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12841 // OpenMP private variables should not be captured in outer scope, so
12842 // just break here.
12843 if (RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) {
12844 if (isOpenMPPrivateVar(Var, OpenMPLevel)) {
12845 Nested = true;
12846 DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType();
12847 CaptureType = Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType);
12848 break;
12849 }
12850 ++OpenMPLevel;
12851 }
12852 }
12853 }
12854 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body,
12855 // we do not want to capture new variables. What was captured
12856 // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing
12857 // should be used.
12858 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) {
12859 if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
12860 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
12861 if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) {
12862 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName();
12863 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
12864 << Var->getDeclName();
12865 Diag(LSI->Lambda->getLocStart(), diag::note_lambda_decl);
12866 } else
12867 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, ExprLoc, Var, DC);
12868 }
12869 return true;
12870 }
12871 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture
12872 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.)
12873 // so check for eligibility.
12874 if (!isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this))
12875 return true;
12876
12877 // Try to capture variable-length arrays types.
12878 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
12879 // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA
12880 // expressions.
12881 QualType QTy = Var->getType();
12882 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var))
12883 QTy = PVD->getOriginalType();
12884 do {
12885 const Type *Ty = QTy.getTypePtr();
12886 switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) {
12887 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
12888 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
12889 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
12890 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
12891 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base)
12892 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
12893 QTy = QualType();
12894 break;
12895 // These types are never variably-modified.
12896 case Type::Builtin:
12897 case Type::Complex:
12898 case Type::Vector:
12899 case Type::ExtVector:
12900 case Type::Record:
12901 case Type::Enum:
12902 case Type::Elaborated:
12903 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
12904 case Type::ObjCObject:
12905 case Type::ObjCInterface:
12906 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
12907 llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!");
12908 case Type::Adjusted:
12909 QTy = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType();
12910 break;
12911 case Type::Decayed:
12912 QTy = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12913 break;
12914 case Type::Pointer:
12915 QTy = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12916 break;
12917 case Type::BlockPointer:
12918 QTy = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12919 break;
12920 case Type::LValueReference:
12921 case Type::RValueReference:
12922 QTy = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12923 break;
12924 case Type::MemberPointer:
12925 QTy = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType();
12926 break;
12927 case Type::ConstantArray:
12928 case Type::IncompleteArray:
12929 // Losing element qualification here is fine.
12930 QTy = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType();
12931 break;
12932 case Type::VariableArray: {
12933 // Losing element qualification here is fine.
12934 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty);
12935
12936 // Unknown size indication requires no size computation.
12937 // Otherwise, evaluate and record it.
12938 if (auto Size = VAT->getSizeExpr()) {
12939 if (!CSI->isVLATypeCaptured(VAT)) {
12940 RecordDecl *CapRecord = nullptr;
12941 if (auto LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12942 CapRecord = LSI->Lambda;
12943 } else if (auto CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
12944 CapRecord = CRSI->TheRecordDecl;
12945 }
12946 if (CapRecord) {
12947 auto ExprLoc = Size->getExprLoc();
12948 auto SizeType = Context.getSizeType();
12949 // Build the non-static data member.
12950 auto Field = FieldDecl::Create(
12951 Context, CapRecord, ExprLoc, ExprLoc,
12952 /*Id*/ nullptr, SizeType, /*TInfo*/ nullptr,
12953 /*BW*/ nullptr, /*Mutable*/ false,
12954 /*InitStyle*/ ICIS_NoInit);
12955 Field->setImplicit(true);
12956 Field->setAccess(AS_private);
12957 Field->setCapturedVLAType(VAT);
12958 CapRecord->addDecl(Field);
12959
12960 CSI->addVLATypeCapture(ExprLoc, SizeType);
12961 }
12962 }
12963 }
12964 QTy = VAT->getElementType();
12965 break;
12966 }
12967 case Type::FunctionProto:
12968 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
12969 QTy = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType();
12970 break;
12971 case Type::Paren:
12972 case Type::TypeOf:
12973 case Type::UnaryTransform:
12974 case Type::Attributed:
12975 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
12976 case Type::PackExpansion:
12977 // Keep walking after single level desugaring.
12978 QTy = QTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(getASTContext());
12979 break;
12980 case Type::Typedef:
12981 QTy = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar();
12982 break;
12983 case Type::Decltype:
12984 QTy = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar();
12985 break;
12986 case Type::Auto:
12987 QTy = cast<AutoType>(Ty)->getDeducedType();
12988 break;
12989 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
12990 QTy = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType();
12991 break;
12992 case Type::Atomic:
12993 QTy = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType();
12994 break;
12995 }
12996 } while (!QTy.isNull() && QTy->isVariablyModifiedType());
12997 }
12998
12999 if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) {
13000 // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture
13001 // so cannot capture this variable.
13002 if (BuildAndDiagnose) {
13003 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName();
13004 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
13005 << Var->getDeclName();
13006 Diag(cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda->getLocStart(),
13007 diag::note_lambda_decl);
13008 // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly
13009 // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we
13010 // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because
13011 // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later. This would purely be done
13012 // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable
13013 // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured
13014 // explicitly. Suggestion:
13015 // - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit
13016 // at the function head
13017 // - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda
13018 // - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable.
13019 }
13020 return true;
13021 }
13022
13023 FunctionScopesIndex--;
13024 DC = ParentDC;
13025 Explicit = false;
13026 } while (!VarDC->Equals(DC));
13027
13028 // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda)
13029 // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific
13030 // requirements, and adding captures if requested.
13031 // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing
13032 // at the lambda nested within that one.
13033 for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N;
13034 ++I) {
13035 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]);
13036
13037 if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
13038 if (!captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc,
13039 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
13040 DeclRefType, Nested, *this))
13041 return true;
13042 Nested = true;
13043 } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) {
13044 if (!captureInCapturedRegion(RSI, Var, ExprLoc,
13045 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
13046 DeclRefType, Nested, *this))
13047 return true;
13048 Nested = true;
13049 } else {
13050 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI);
13051 if (!captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc,
13052 BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType,
13053 DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc,
13054 /*IsTopScope*/I == N - 1, *this))
13055 return true;
13056 Nested = true;
13057 }
13058 }
13059 return false;
13060 }
13061
tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc,TryCaptureKind Kind,SourceLocation EllipsisLoc)13062 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc,
13063 TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) {
13064 QualType CaptureType;
13065 QualType DeclRefType;
13066 return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc,
13067 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType,
13068 DeclRefType, nullptr);
13069 }
13070
NeedToCaptureVariable(VarDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc)13071 bool Sema::NeedToCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) {
13072 QualType CaptureType;
13073 QualType DeclRefType;
13074 return !tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(),
13075 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType,
13076 DeclRefType, nullptr);
13077 }
13078
getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl * Var,SourceLocation Loc)13079 QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) {
13080 QualType CaptureType;
13081 QualType DeclRefType;
13082
13083 // Determine whether we can capture this variable.
13084 if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(),
13085 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType,
13086 DeclRefType, nullptr))
13087 return QualType();
13088
13089 return DeclRefType;
13090 }
13091
13092
13093
13094 // If either the type of the variable or the initializer is dependent,
13095 // return false. Otherwise, determine whether the variable is a constant
13096 // expression. Use this if you need to know if a variable that might or
13097 // might not be dependent is truly a constant expression.
IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(VarDecl * Var,ASTContext & Context)13098 static inline bool IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(VarDecl *Var,
13099 ASTContext &Context) {
13100
13101 if (Var->getType()->isDependentType())
13102 return false;
13103 const VarDecl *DefVD = nullptr;
13104 Var->getAnyInitializer(DefVD);
13105 if (!DefVD)
13106 return false;
13107 EvaluatedStmt *Eval = DefVD->ensureEvaluatedStmt();
13108 Expr *Init = cast<Expr>(Eval->Value);
13109 if (Init->isValueDependent())
13110 return false;
13111 return IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, Context);
13112 }
13113
13114
UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Expr * E)13115 void Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Expr *E) {
13116 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is
13117 // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a
13118 // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1)
13119 // is immediately applied." This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue
13120 // conversion part.
13121 MaybeODRUseExprs.erase(E->IgnoreParens());
13122
13123 // If we are in a lambda, check if this DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr refers
13124 // to a variable that is a constant expression, and if so, identify it as
13125 // a reference to a variable that does not involve an odr-use of that
13126 // variable.
13127 if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) {
13128 Expr *SansParensExpr = E->IgnoreParens();
13129 VarDecl *Var = nullptr;
13130 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SansParensExpr))
13131 Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getFoundDecl());
13132 else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(SansParensExpr))
13133 Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
13134
13135 if (Var && IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, Context))
13136 LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(SansParensExpr);
13137 }
13138 }
13139
ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res)13140 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) {
13141 Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Res);
13142
13143 if (!Res.isUsable())
13144 return Res;
13145
13146 // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay
13147 // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the
13148 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion. In the one case where this doesn't happen
13149 // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway.
13150 UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(Res.get());
13151 return Res;
13152 }
13153
CleanupVarDeclMarking()13154 void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() {
13155 for (llvm::SmallPtrSetIterator<Expr*> i = MaybeODRUseExprs.begin(),
13156 e = MaybeODRUseExprs.end();
13157 i != e; ++i) {
13158 VarDecl *Var;
13159 SourceLocation Loc;
13160 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(*i)) {
13161 Var = cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
13162 Loc = DRE->getLocation();
13163 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(*i)) {
13164 Var = cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
13165 Loc = ME->getMemberLoc();
13166 } else {
13167 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected expression");
13168 }
13169
13170 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, *this,
13171 /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex Pointer*/ nullptr);
13172 }
13173
13174 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear();
13175 }
13176
13177
DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema & SemaRef,SourceLocation Loc,VarDecl * Var,Expr * E)13178 static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc,
13179 VarDecl *Var, Expr *E) {
13180 assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E)) &&
13181 "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced");
13182 Var->setReferenced();
13183
13184 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind();
13185 bool MarkODRUsed = true;
13186
13187 // If the context is not potentially evaluated, this is not an odr-use and
13188 // does not trigger instantiation.
13189 if (!IsPotentiallyEvaluatedContext(SemaRef)) {
13190 if (SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext())
13191 return;
13192
13193 // If we don't yet know whether this context is going to end up being an
13194 // evaluated context, and we're referencing a variable from an enclosing
13195 // scope, add a potential capture.
13196 //
13197 // FIXME: Is this necessary? These contexts are only used for default
13198 // arguments, where local variables can't be used.
13199 const bool RefersToEnclosingScope =
13200 (SemaRef.CurContext != Var->getDeclContext() &&
13201 Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && Var->hasLocalStorage());
13202 if (RefersToEnclosingScope) {
13203 if (LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI = SemaRef.getCurLambda()) {
13204 // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so
13205 // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any
13206 // lvalue-to-rvalue
13207 // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use.
13208 // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed
13209 // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking
13210 // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant
13211 // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used).
13212 assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression.");
13213 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() ||
13214 !IsVariableNonDependentAndAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context))
13215 LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens());
13216 }
13217 }
13218
13219 if (!isTemplateInstantiation(TSK))
13220 return;
13221
13222 // Instantiate, but do not mark as odr-used, variable templates.
13223 MarkODRUsed = false;
13224 }
13225
13226 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec =
13227 dyn_cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var);
13228 assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) &&
13229 "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization.");
13230
13231 // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member
13232 // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay
13233 // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used
13234 // in a constant expression.
13235 if (isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) {
13236 bool TryInstantiating = TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation;
13237
13238 if (TryInstantiating && !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) {
13239 if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid()) {
13240 // This is a modification of an existing AST node. Notify listeners.
13241 if (ASTMutationListener *L = SemaRef.getASTMutationListener())
13242 L->StaticDataMemberInstantiated(Var);
13243 } else if (!Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context))
13244 // Don't bother trying to instantiate it again, unless we might need
13245 // its initializer before we get to the end of the TU.
13246 TryInstantiating = false;
13247 }
13248
13249 if (Var->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
13250 Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, Loc);
13251
13252 if (TryInstantiating) {
13253 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Var->getPointOfInstantiation();
13254 bool InstantiationDependent = false;
13255 bool IsNonDependent =
13256 VarSpec ? !TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments(
13257 VarSpec->getTemplateArgsInfo(), InstantiationDependent)
13258 : true;
13259
13260 // Do not instantiate specializations that are still type-dependent.
13261 if (IsNonDependent) {
13262 if (Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) {
13263 // Do not defer instantiations of variables which could be used in a
13264 // constant expression.
13265 SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var);
13266 } else {
13267 SemaRef.PendingInstantiations
13268 .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation));
13269 }
13270 }
13271 }
13272 }
13273
13274 if(!MarkODRUsed) return;
13275
13276 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it satisfies
13277 // the requirements for appearing in a constant expression (5.19) and, if
13278 // it is an object, the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1)
13279 // is immediately applied." We check the first part here, and
13280 // Sema::UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue deals with the second part.
13281 // Note that we use the C++11 definition everywhere because nothing in
13282 // C++03 depends on whether we get the C++03 version correct. The second
13283 // part does not apply to references, since they are not objects.
13284 if (E && IsVariableAConstantExpression(Var, SemaRef.Context)) {
13285 // A reference initialized by a constant expression can never be
13286 // odr-used, so simply ignore it.
13287 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType())
13288 SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E);
13289 } else
13290 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef,
13291 /*MaxFunctionScopeIndex ptr*/ nullptr);
13292 }
13293
13294 /// \brief Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used
13295 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3). Note that this should not be
13296 /// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl.
MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc,VarDecl * Var)13297 void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) {
13298 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr);
13299 }
13300
MarkExprReferenced(Sema & SemaRef,SourceLocation Loc,Decl * D,Expr * E,bool OdrUse)13301 static void MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc,
13302 Decl *D, Expr *E, bool OdrUse) {
13303 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
13304 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E);
13305 return;
13306 }
13307
13308 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, OdrUse);
13309
13310 // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the
13311 // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call.
13312 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E);
13313 if (!ME)
13314 return;
13315 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
13316 if (!MD)
13317 return;
13318 // Only attempt to devirtualize if this is truly a virtual call.
13319 bool IsVirtualCall = MD->isVirtual() && !ME->hasQualifier();
13320 if (!IsVirtualCall)
13321 return;
13322 const Expr *Base = ME->getBase();
13323 const CXXRecordDecl *MostDerivedClassDecl = Base->getBestDynamicClassType();
13324 if (!MostDerivedClassDecl)
13325 return;
13326 CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getCorrespondingMethodInClass(MostDerivedClassDecl);
13327 if (!DM || DM->isPure())
13328 return;
13329 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, OdrUse);
13330 }
13331
13332 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr.
MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr * E)13333 void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13334 // TODO: update this with DR# once a defect report is filed.
13335 // C++11 defect. The address of a pure member should not be an ODR use, even
13336 // if it's a qualified reference.
13337 bool OdrUse = true;
13338 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl()))
13339 if (Method->isVirtual())
13340 OdrUse = false;
13341 MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse);
13342 }
13343
13344 /// \brief Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr.
MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr * E)13345 void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) {
13346 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2:
13347 // A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated
13348 // expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by
13349 // overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated
13350 // expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its
13351 // name is not explicitly qualified.
13352 bool OdrUse = true;
13353 if (!E->hasQualifier()) {
13354 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl()))
13355 if (Method->isPure())
13356 OdrUse = false;
13357 }
13358 SourceLocation Loc = E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ?
13359 E->getMemberLoc() : E->getLocStart();
13360 MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, OdrUse);
13361 }
13362
13363 /// \brief Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration. It
13364 /// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for
13365 /// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a
13366 /// normal expression which refers to a variable.
MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc,Decl * D,bool OdrUse)13367 void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, bool OdrUse) {
13368 if (OdrUse) {
13369 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
13370 MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD);
13371 return;
13372 }
13373 }
13374 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
13375 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD, OdrUse);
13376 return;
13377 }
13378 D->setReferenced();
13379 }
13380
13381 namespace {
13382 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
13383 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
13384 // of when we're entering
13385 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
13386 Sema &S;
13387 SourceLocation Loc;
13388
13389 public:
13390 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
13391
MarkReferencedDecls(Sema & S,SourceLocation Loc)13392 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
13393
13394 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
13395 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
13396 };
13397 }
13398
TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument & Arg)13399 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
13400 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
13401 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
13402 if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl())
13403 S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true);
13404 }
13405
13406 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
13407 }
13408
TraverseRecordType(RecordType * T)13409 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
13410 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
13411 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
13412 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
13413 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
13414 }
13415
13416 return true;
13417 }
13418
MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc,QualType T)13419 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
13420 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
13421 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
13422 }
13423
13424 namespace {
13425 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
13426 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
13427 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
13428 Sema &S;
13429 bool SkipLocalVariables;
13430
13431 public:
13432 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
13433
EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema & S,bool SkipLocalVariables)13434 EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables)
13435 : Inherited(S.Context), S(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables) { }
13436
VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr * E)13437 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13438 // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't.
13439 if (SkipLocalVariables) {
13440 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl()))
13441 if (VD->hasLocalStorage())
13442 return;
13443 }
13444
13445 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E);
13446 }
13447
VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr * E)13448 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
13449 S.MarkMemberReferenced(E);
13450 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
13451 }
13452
VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr * E)13453 void VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E) {
13454 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
13455 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(E->getTemporary()->getDestructor()));
13456 Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13457 }
13458
VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr * E)13459 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
13460 if (E->getOperatorNew())
13461 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
13462 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
13463 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
13464 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
13465 }
13466
VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr * E)13467 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
13468 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
13469 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
13470 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
13471 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
13472 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
13473 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
13474 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
13475 }
13476
13477 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
13478 }
13479
VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr * E)13480 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
13481 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
13482 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
13483 }
13484
VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr * E)13485 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
13486 Visit(E->getExpr());
13487 }
13488
VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr * E)13489 void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
13490 Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E);
13491
13492 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue)
13493 S.UpdateMarkingForLValueToRValue(E->getSubExpr());
13494 }
13495 };
13496 }
13497
13498 /// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
13499 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
13500 ///
13501 /// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as
13502 /// 'referenced'.
MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr * E,bool SkipLocalVariables)13503 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E,
13504 bool SkipLocalVariables) {
13505 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables).Visit(E);
13506 }
13507
13508 /// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
13509 /// of the program being compiled.
13510 ///
13511 /// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
13512 /// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
13513 /// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
13514 /// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
13515 /// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
13516 /// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
13517 /// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
13518 /// later.
13519 ///
13520 /// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
13521 /// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
13522 /// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
13523 /// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,const Stmt * Statement,const PartialDiagnostic & PD)13524 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement,
13525 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
13526 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
13527 case Unevaluated:
13528 case UnevaluatedAbstract:
13529 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
13530 break;
13531
13532 case ConstantEvaluated:
13533 // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation.
13534 break;
13535
13536 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
13537 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
13538 if (Statement && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) {
13539 FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags.
13540 push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Statement));
13541 }
13542 else
13543 Diag(Loc, PD);
13544
13545 return true;
13546 }
13547
13548 return false;
13549 }
13550
CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType,SourceLocation Loc,CallExpr * CE,FunctionDecl * FD)13551 bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
13552 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
13553 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
13554 return false;
13555
13556 // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return
13557 // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call.
13558 if (ExprEvalContexts.back().IsDecltype) {
13559 ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE);
13560 return false;
13561 }
13562
13563 class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser {
13564 FunctionDecl *FD;
13565 CallExpr *CE;
13566
13567 public:
13568 CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE)
13569 : FD(FD), CE(CE) { }
13570
13571 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
13572 if (!FD) {
13573 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
13574 << T << CE->getSourceRange();
13575 return;
13576 }
13577
13578 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
13579 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() << T;
13580 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at)
13581 << FD->getDeclName();
13582 }
13583 } Diagnoser(FD, CE);
13584
13585 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser))
13586 return true;
13587
13588 return false;
13589 }
13590
13591 // Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses
13592 // will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr * E)13593 void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
13594 SourceLocation Loc;
13595
13596 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
13597 bool IsOrAssign = false;
13598
13599 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
13600 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign)
13601 return;
13602
13603 IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign;
13604
13605 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
13606 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
13607 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
13608 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
13609
13610 // self = [<foo> init...]
13611 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init)
13612 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
13613
13614 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
13615 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject")
13616 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
13617 }
13618
13619 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
13620 } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
13621 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual)
13622 return;
13623
13624 IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual;
13625 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
13626 } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E))
13627 return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm());
13628 else {
13629 // Not an assignment.
13630 return;
13631 }
13632
13633 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
13634
13635 SourceLocation Open = E->getLocStart();
13636 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
13637 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
13638 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
13639 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
13640
13641 if (IsOrAssign)
13642 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison)
13643 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!=");
13644 else
13645 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
13646 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
13647 }
13648
13649 /// \brief Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate
13650 /// that the user intended an assignment used as condition.
DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr * ParenE)13651 void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) {
13652 // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro.
13653 SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getLocStart();
13654 if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID())
13655 return;
13656 // Don't warn for dependent expressions.
13657 if (ParenE->isTypeDependent())
13658 return;
13659
13660 Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens();
13661
13662 if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E))
13663 if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ &&
13664 opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context)
13665 == Expr::MLV_Valid) {
13666 SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc();
13667
13668 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange();
13669 SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange();
13670 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence)
13671 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin())
13672 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd());
13673 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign)
13674 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=");
13675 }
13676 }
13677
CheckBooleanCondition(Expr * E,SourceLocation Loc)13678 ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
13679 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
13680 if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E))
13681 DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE);
13682
13683 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
13684 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13685 E = result.get();
13686
13687 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
13688 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13689 return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E); // C++ 6.4p4
13690
13691 ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
13692 if (ERes.isInvalid())
13693 return ExprError();
13694 E = ERes.get();
13695
13696 QualType T = E->getType();
13697 if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
13698 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
13699 << T << E->getSourceRange();
13700 return ExprError();
13701 }
13702 CheckBoolLikeConversion(E, Loc);
13703 }
13704
13705 return E;
13706 }
13707
ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope * S,SourceLocation Loc,Expr * SubExpr)13708 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
13709 Expr *SubExpr) {
13710 if (!SubExpr)
13711 return ExprError();
13712
13713 return CheckBooleanCondition(SubExpr, Loc);
13714 }
13715
13716 namespace {
13717 /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression
13718 /// to have an appropriate type.
13719 struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction
13720 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> {
13721
13722 Sema &S;
13723
RebuildUnknownAnyFunction__anonf9777e2d0b11::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction13724 RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
13725
VisitStmt__anonf9777e2d0b11::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction13726 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
13727 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
13728 }
13729
VisitExpr__anonf9777e2d0b11::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction13730 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
13731 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call)
13732 << E->getSourceRange();
13733 return ExprError();
13734 }
13735
13736 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
13737 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
rebuildSugarExpr__anonf9777e2d0b11::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction13738 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
13739 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13740 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13741
13742 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
13743 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
13744 E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
13745 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
13746 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13747 return E;
13748 }
13749
VisitParenExpr__anonf9777e2d0b11::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction13750 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
13751 return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13752 }
13753
VisitUnaryExtension__anonf9777e2d0b11::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction13754 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
13755 return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13756 }
13757
VisitUnaryAddrOf__anonf9777e2d0b11::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction13758 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
13759 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13760 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13761
13762 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
13763 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
13764 E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()));
13765 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13766 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13767 return E;
13768 }
13769
resolveDecl__anonf9777e2d0b11::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction13770 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
13771 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E);
13772
13773 E->setType(VD->getType());
13774
13775 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13776 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
13777 !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) &&
13778 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance()))
13779 E->setValueKind(VK_LValue);
13780
13781 return E;
13782 }
13783
VisitMemberExpr__anonf9777e2d0b11::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction13784 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
13785 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
13786 }
13787
VisitDeclRefExpr__anonf9777e2d0b11::RebuildUnknownAnyFunction13788 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13789 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
13790 }
13791 };
13792 }
13793
13794 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it
13795 /// to have a function type.
rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema & S,Expr * FunctionExpr)13796 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) {
13797 ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr);
13798 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13799 return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get());
13800 }
13801
13802 namespace {
13803 /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype
13804 /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring
13805 /// expression. Strict preservation of the original source
13806 /// structure is not a goal.
13807 struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr
13808 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> {
13809
13810 Sema &S;
13811
13812 /// The current destination type.
13813 QualType DestType;
13814
RebuildUnknownAnyExpr__anonf9777e2d0c11::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr13815 RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType)
13816 : S(S), DestType(CastType) {}
13817
VisitStmt__anonf9777e2d0c11::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr13818 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) {
13819 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!");
13820 }
13821
VisitExpr__anonf9777e2d0c11::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr13822 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) {
13823 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
13824 << E->getSourceRange();
13825 return ExprError();
13826 }
13827
13828 ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E);
13829 ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E);
13830
13831 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another
13832 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of.
rebuildSugarExpr__anonf9777e2d0c11::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr13833 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) {
13834 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13835 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13836 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get();
13837 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr);
13838 E->setType(SubExpr->getType());
13839 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind());
13840 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13841 return E;
13842 }
13843
VisitParenExpr__anonf9777e2d0c11::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr13844 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) {
13845 return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13846 }
13847
VisitUnaryExtension__anonf9777e2d0c11::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr13848 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) {
13849 return rebuildSugarExpr(E);
13850 }
13851
VisitUnaryAddrOf__anonf9777e2d0c11::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr13852 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) {
13853 const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>();
13854 if (!Ptr) {
13855 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof)
13856 << E->getSourceRange();
13857 return ExprError();
13858 }
13859 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
13860 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13861 E->setType(DestType);
13862
13863 // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type.
13864 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
13865 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
13866 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
13867 E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get());
13868 return E;
13869 }
13870
13871 ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E);
13872
13873 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD);
13874
VisitMemberExpr__anonf9777e2d0c11::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr13875 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
13876 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl());
13877 }
13878
VisitDeclRefExpr__anonf9777e2d0c11::RebuildUnknownAnyExpr13879 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
13880 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl());
13881 }
13882 };
13883 }
13884
13885 /// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype.
VisitCallExpr(CallExpr * E)13886 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) {
13887 Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee();
13888
13889 enum FnKind {
13890 FK_MemberFunction,
13891 FK_FunctionPointer,
13892 FK_BlockPointer
13893 };
13894
13895 FnKind Kind;
13896 QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType();
13897 if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) {
13898 assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E));
13899 Kind = FK_MemberFunction;
13900 CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr);
13901 } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
13902 CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
13903 Kind = FK_FunctionPointer;
13904 } else {
13905 CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
13906 Kind = FK_BlockPointer;
13907 }
13908 const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>();
13909
13910 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function.
13911 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
13912 unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function;
13913 if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer)
13914 diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function;
13915
13916 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID)
13917 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
13918 return ExprError();
13919 }
13920
13921 // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result.
13922 E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context));
13923 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
13924 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
13925
13926 // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType.
13927 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType);
13928 if (Proto) {
13929 // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when
13930 // it has no idea what a function's signature is.
13931 //
13932 // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R
13933 // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++
13934 // would foul up all sorts of assumptions. However, we cannot
13935 // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we
13936 // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see
13937 // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic.
13938 // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to
13939 // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype
13940 // "A foo(B,C,D,...);". The only known exception is with the
13941 // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl
13942 // regardless of its normal CC. Therefore we change the parameter
13943 // types to match the types of the arguments.
13944 //
13945 // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the
13946 // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST.
13947
13948 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes();
13949 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
13950 if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case
13951 ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs());
13952 for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) {
13953 Expr *Arg = E->getArg(i);
13954 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType();
13955 if (E->isLValue()) {
13956 ArgType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArgType);
13957 } else if (E->isXValue()) {
13958 ArgType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(ArgType);
13959 }
13960 ArgTypes.push_back(ArgType);
13961 }
13962 ParamTypes = ArgTypes;
13963 }
13964 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes,
13965 Proto->getExtProtoInfo());
13966 } else {
13967 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType,
13968 FnType->getExtInfo());
13969 }
13970
13971 // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type.
13972 switch (Kind) {
13973 case FK_MemberFunction:
13974 // Nothing to do.
13975 break;
13976
13977 case FK_FunctionPointer:
13978 DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType);
13979 break;
13980
13981 case FK_BlockPointer:
13982 DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType);
13983 break;
13984 }
13985
13986 // Finally, we can recurse.
13987 ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr);
13988 if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError();
13989 E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get());
13990
13991 // Bind a temporary if necessary.
13992 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
13993 }
13994
VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr * E)13995 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {
13996 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call.
13997 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) {
13998 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function)
13999 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType;
14000 return ExprError();
14001 }
14002
14003 // Rewrite the method result type if available.
14004 if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) {
14005 assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy);
14006 Method->setReturnType(DestType);
14007 }
14008
14009 // Change the type of the message.
14010 E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType());
14011 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType));
14012
14013 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E);
14014 }
14015
VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr * E)14016 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
14017 // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay.
14018 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) {
14019 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
14020 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
14021
14022 E->setType(DestType);
14023
14024 // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type.
14025 DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
14026
14027 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
14028 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
14029
14030 E->setSubExpr(Result.get());
14031 return E;
14032 } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) {
14033 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue);
14034 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary);
14035
14036 assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType()));
14037
14038 E->setType(DestType);
14039
14040 // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such.
14041 DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType);
14042
14043 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr());
14044 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
14045
14046 E->setSubExpr(Result.get());
14047 return E;
14048 } else {
14049 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!");
14050 }
14051 }
14052
resolveDecl(Expr * E,ValueDecl * VD)14053 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) {
14054 ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue;
14055 QualType Type = DestType;
14056
14057 // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls:
14058
14059 // - functions
14060 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) {
14061 if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) {
14062 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType();
14063 ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD);
14064 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
14065 return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type,
14066 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue);
14067 }
14068
14069 if (!Type->isFunctionType()) {
14070 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function)
14071 << VD << E->getSourceRange();
14072 return ExprError();
14073 }
14074 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = Type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
14075 // We must match the FunctionDecl's type to the hack introduced in
14076 // RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr to vararg functions of unknown
14077 // type. See the lengthy commentary in that routine.
14078 QualType FDT = FD->getType();
14079 const FunctionType *FnType = FDT->castAs<FunctionType>();
14080 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FnType);
14081 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
14082 if (DRE && Proto && Proto->getParamTypes().empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) {
14083 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation();
14084 FunctionDecl *NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(FD->getASTContext(),
14085 FD->getDeclContext(),
14086 Loc, Loc, FD->getNameInfo().getName(),
14087 DestType, FD->getTypeSourceInfo(),
14088 SC_None, false/*isInlineSpecified*/,
14089 FD->hasPrototype(),
14090 false/*isConstexprSpecified*/);
14091
14092 if (FD->getQualifier())
14093 NewFD->setQualifierInfo(FD->getQualifierLoc());
14094
14095 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
14096 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) {
14097 ParmVarDecl *Param =
14098 S.BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(FD, Loc, AI);
14099 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
14100 Params.push_back(Param);
14101 }
14102 NewFD->setParams(Params);
14103 DRE->setDecl(NewFD);
14104 VD = DRE->getDecl();
14105 }
14106 }
14107
14108 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
14109 if (MD->isInstance()) {
14110 ValueKind = VK_RValue;
14111 Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy;
14112 }
14113
14114 // Function references aren't l-values in C.
14115 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
14116 ValueKind = VK_RValue;
14117
14118 // - variables
14119 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) {
14120 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
14121 Type = RefTy->getPointeeType();
14122 } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) {
14123 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type)
14124 << VD << E->getSourceRange();
14125 return ExprError();
14126 }
14127
14128 // - nothing else
14129 } else {
14130 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl)
14131 << VD << E->getSourceRange();
14132 return ExprError();
14133 }
14134
14135 // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but
14136 // also really dangerous.
14137 VD->setType(DestType);
14138 E->setType(Type);
14139 E->setValueKind(ValueKind);
14140 return E;
14141 }
14142
14143 /// Check a cast of an unknown-any type. We intentionally only
14144 /// trigger this for C-style casts.
checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange,QualType CastType,Expr * CastExpr,CastKind & CastKind,ExprValueKind & VK,CXXCastPath & Path)14145 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType,
14146 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind,
14147 ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) {
14148 // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch.
14149 ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr);
14150 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
14151
14152 CastExpr = result.get();
14153 VK = CastExpr->getValueKind();
14154 CastKind = CK_NoOp;
14155
14156 return CastExpr;
14157 }
14158
forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr * E,QualType ToType)14159 ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) {
14160 return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E);
14161 }
14162
checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc,Expr * arg,QualType & paramType)14163 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc,
14164 Expr *arg, QualType ¶mType) {
14165 // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of
14166 // any sort, just do default argument promotion.
14167 ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens());
14168 if (!castArg) {
14169 ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg);
14170 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
14171 paramType = result.get()->getType();
14172 return result;
14173 }
14174
14175 // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast.
14176 assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType());
14177 paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten();
14178
14179 // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type.
14180 InitializedEntity entity =
14181 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType,
14182 /*consumed*/ false);
14183 return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg);
14184 }
14185
diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema & S,Expr * E)14186 static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) {
14187 Expr *orig = E;
14188 unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any;
14189 while (true) {
14190 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
14191 if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) {
14192 E = call->getCallee();
14193 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
14194 } else {
14195 break;
14196 }
14197 }
14198
14199 SourceLocation loc;
14200 NamedDecl *d;
14201 if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
14202 loc = ref->getLocation();
14203 d = ref->getDecl();
14204 } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) {
14205 loc = mem->getMemberLoc();
14206 d = mem->getMemberDecl();
14207 } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) {
14208 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any;
14209 loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc();
14210 d = msg->getMethodDecl();
14211 if (!d) {
14212 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method)
14213 << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector()
14214 << orig->getSourceRange();
14215 return ExprError();
14216 }
14217 } else {
14218 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr)
14219 << E->getSourceRange();
14220 return ExprError();
14221 }
14222
14223 S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange();
14224
14225 // Never recoverable.
14226 return ExprError();
14227 }
14228
14229 /// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
14230 /// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr * E)14231 ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) {
14232 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
14233 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it
14234 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have
14235 // been dealt with before checking the operands.
14236 ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(E);
14237 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError();
14238 E = Result.get();
14239 }
14240
14241 const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType();
14242 if (!placeholderType) return E;
14243
14244 switch (placeholderType->getKind()) {
14245
14246 // Overloaded expressions.
14247 case BuiltinType::Overload: {
14248 // Try to resolve a single function template specialization.
14249 // This is obligatory.
14250 ExprResult result = E;
14251 if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(result, false)) {
14252 return result;
14253
14254 // If that failed, try to recover with a call.
14255 } else {
14256 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable),
14257 /*complain*/ true);
14258 return result;
14259 }
14260 }
14261
14262 // Bound member functions.
14263 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: {
14264 ExprResult result = E;
14265 const Expr *BME = E->IgnoreParens();
14266 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function);
14267 // Try to give a nicer diagnostic if it is a bound member that we recognize.
14268 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(BME)) {
14269 PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*pseudo-destructor*/ 1;
14270 } else if (const auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(BME)) {
14271 if (ME->getMemberNameInfo().getName().getNameKind() ==
14272 DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName)
14273 PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*destructor*/ 0;
14274 }
14275 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PD,
14276 /*complain*/ true);
14277 return result;
14278 }
14279
14280 // ARC unbridged casts.
14281 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: {
14282 Expr *realCast = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
14283 diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast);
14284 return realCast;
14285 }
14286
14287 // Expressions of unknown type.
14288 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny:
14289 return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E);
14290
14291 // Pseudo-objects.
14292 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject:
14293 return checkPseudoObjectRValue(E);
14294
14295 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: {
14296 // Accept __noop without parens by implicitly converting it to a call expr.
14297 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
14298 if (DRE) {
14299 auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
14300 if (FD->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__noop) {
14301 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(FD->getType()),
14302 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get();
14303 return new (Context) CallExpr(Context, E, None, Context.IntTy,
14304 VK_RValue, SourceLocation());
14305 }
14306 }
14307
14308 Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use);
14309 return ExprError();
14310 }
14311
14312 // Everything else should be impossible.
14313 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) \
14314 case BuiltinType::Id:
14315 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId)
14316 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
14317 break;
14318 }
14319
14320 llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!");
14321 }
14322
CheckCaseExpression(Expr * E)14323 bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) {
14324 if (E->isTypeDependent())
14325 return true;
14326 if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context))
14327 return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType();
14328 return false;
14329 }
14330
14331 /// ActOnObjCBoolLiteral - Parse {__objc_yes,__objc_no} literals.
14332 ExprResult
ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc,tok::TokenKind Kind)14333 Sema::ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind) {
14334 assert((Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes || Kind == tok::kw___objc_no) &&
14335 "Unknown Objective-C Boolean value!");
14336 QualType BoolT = Context.ObjCBuiltinBoolTy;
14337 if (!Context.getBOOLDecl()) {
14338 LookupResult Result(*this, &Context.Idents.get("BOOL"), OpLoc,
14339 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
14340 if (LookupName(Result, getCurScope()) && Result.isSingleResult()) {
14341 NamedDecl *ND = Result.getFoundDecl();
14342 if (TypedefDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(ND))
14343 Context.setBOOLDecl(TD);
14344 }
14345 }
14346 if (Context.getBOOLDecl())
14347 BoolT = Context.getBOOLType();
14348 return new (Context)
14349 ObjCBoolLiteralExpr(Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes, BoolT, OpLoc);
14350 }
14351